Product Folder Sample & Buy Technical Documents Tools & Software Support & Community Reference Design MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 MSP430F522x, MSP430F521x Mixed-Signal Microcontrollers 1 Device Overview 1.1 Features 1 • Dual-Supply Voltage Device – Primary Supply (AVCC, DVCC): • Powered From External Supply: 3.6 V Down to 1.8 V • Up to 22 General-Purpose I/Os With up to Four External Interrupts – Low-Voltage Interface Supply (DVIO): • Powered From Separate External Supply: 1.62 V to 1.98 V • Up to 31 General-Purpose I/Os With up to 12 External Interrupts • Serial Communications • Ultra-Low Power Consumption – Active Mode (AM): All System Clocks Active 290 µA/MHz at 8 MHz, 3.0 V, Flash Program Execution (Typical) 150 µA/MHz at 8 MHz, 3.0 V, RAM Program Execution (Typical) – Standby Mode (LPM3): Real-Time Clock (RTC) With Crystal, Watchdog, and Supply Supervisor Operational, Full RAM Retention, Fast Wakeup: 1.9 µA at 2.2 V, 2.1 µA at 3.0 V (Typical) Low-Power Oscillator (VLO), General-Purpose Counter, Watchdog, and Supply Supervisor Operational, Full RAM Retention, Fast Wakeup: 1.4 µA at 3.0 V (Typical) – Off Mode (LPM4): Full RAM Retention, Supply Supervisor Operational, Fast Wakeup: 1.1 µA at 3.0 V (Typical) – Shutdown Mode (LPM4.5): 0.18 µA at 3.0 V (Typical) • Wake up From Standby Mode in 3.5 µs (Typical) • 16-Bit RISC Architecture, Extended Memory, up to 25-MHz System Clock • Flexible Power-Management System – Fully Integrated LDO With Programmable Regulated Core Supply Voltage – Supply Voltage Supervision, Monitoring, and Brownout • Unified Clock System – FLL Control Loop for Frequency Stabilization – Low-Power Low-Frequency Internal Clock Source (VLO) – Low-Frequency Trimmed Internal Reference Source (REFO) – 32-kHz Watch Crystals (XT1) – High-Frequency Crystals up to 32 MHz (XT2) • 16-Bit Timer TA0, Timer_A With Five Capture/Compare Registers • 16-Bit Timer TA1, Timer_A With Three Capture/Compare Registers • 16-Bit Timer TA2, Timer_A With Three Capture/Compare Registers • 16-Bit Timer TB0, Timer_B With Seven Capture/Compare Shadow Registers • Two Universal Serial Communication Interfaces – USCI_A0 and USCI_A1 Each Support: • Enhanced UART With Automatic Baud Rate Detection • IrDA Encoder and Decoder • Synchronous SPI – USCI_B0 and USCI_B1 Each Support: • I2C • Synchronous SPI • 10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) With Internal Reference, Sample-and-Hold • Comparator • Hardware Multiplier Supports 32-Bit Operations • Serial Onboard Programming, No External Programming Voltage Needed • Three-Channel Internal DMA • Basic Timer With RTC Feature • Section 3 Summarizes Available Family Members • For Complete Module Descriptions, See the MSP430x5xx and MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide (SLAU208) • For Design Guidelines, See Designing With MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x Devices (SLAA558) 1 An IMPORTANT NOTICE at the end of this data sheet addresses availability, warranty, changes, use in safety-critical applications, intellectual property matters and other important disclaimers. PRODUCTION DATA. MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 1.2 • • Applications Analog and Digital Sensor Systems Data Loggers 1.3 www.ti.com • General-Purpose Applications Description The TI MSP430™ family of ultra-low-power microcontrollers consists of several devices featuring different sets of peripherals targeted for various applications. The architecture, combined with extensive low-power modes, is optimized to achieve extended battery life in portable measurement applications. The device features a powerful 16-bit RISC CPU, 16-bit registers, and constant generators that contribute to maximum code efficiency. The digitally controlled oscillator (DCO) allows the device to wake up from lowpower modes to active mode in 3.5 µs (typical). The MSP430F522x series are microcontrollers with four 16-bit timers, a high-performance 10-bit ADC, two universal serial communication interfaces (USCIs), a hardware multiplier, DMA, a comparator, and an RTC module with alarm capabilities. The MSP430F521x series include all of the peripherals of the MSP430F522x series with the exception of the ADC. All devices have a split I/O supply system that allows for a seamless interface to other devices that have a nominal 1.8-V I/O interface without the need for external level translation. Typical applications include analog and digital sensor systems, data loggers, and various general-purpose applications. Device Information (1) PACKAGE BODY SIZE (2) MSP430F5229IRGC VQFN (64) 9 mm × 9 mm MSP430F5229IZQE BGA (80) 5 mm × 5 mm PART NUMBER MSP430F5224IRGZ VQFN (48) 7 mm × 7 mm MSP430F5219IYFF DSBGA (64) See Section 8 (1) (2) 2 For the most current part, package, and ordering information, see the Package Option Addendum in Section 8, or see the TI website at www.ti.com. The dimensions shown here are approximations. For the package dimensions with tolerances, see the Mechanical Data in Section 8. Device Overview Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com 1.4 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Functional Block Diagrams Figure 1-1 shows the functional block diagram for the MSP430F5229 and MSP430F5227 devices in the RGC, ZQE, YFF packages. XIN XOUT XT2IN XT2OUT Unified Clock System RSTDVCC RST/NMI BSLEN ACLK 8KB Power Management Flash RAM LDO SVM/SVS Brownout PA DVIO VCORE P1.x P2.x SYS P1 P1 P2 1×4 I/Os 1×4 I/Os 1×8 I/Os Watchdog PA 1×16 I/Os Port Map Control (P4) I/O Ports Interrupt and Wakeup SMCLK MCLK CPUXV2 and Working Registers 128KB 64KB DVCC AVCC DVSS AVSS P3.x PB P4.x P5.x PC P6.x PJ PD P7.x PJ.x P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 1×5 I/Os 1×8 I/Os 1×6 I/Os 1×8 I/Os 1×6 I/Os PB 1×13 I/Os PC 1×14 I/Os USCI0,1 PD PJ 1×6 I/Os 1×4 I/Os I/O Ports USCI_Ax: UART, IrDA, SPI USCI_Bx: SPI, I2C MAB DMA MDB 3 Channel EEM (S: 3+1) ADC10_A JTAG, SBW Interface MPY32 TA0 TA1 TA2 TB0 Timer_A 5 CC Registers Timer_A 3 CC Registers Timer_A 3 CC Registers Timer_B 7 CC Registers RTC_A CRC16 10 Bit 200 KSPS 12 Channels (10 ext,2 int) COMP_B REF 8 Channels I/O are supplied by DVIO Figure 1-1. Functional Block Diagram – F5229, F5227 – RGC, ZQE, YFF Packages Device Overview Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 3 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Figure 1-2 shows the functional block diagram for the MSP430F5224 and MSP430F5222 devices in the RGZ package. XIN XOUT RSTDVCC RST/NMI BSLEN DVCC AVCC DVSS AVSS PA DVIO VCORE P1.x XT2IN XT2OUT Unified Clock System ACLK 8KB Power Management SYS P1 P1 P2 1×4 I/Os 1×4 I/Os 1×1 I/Os Watchdog PA 1×9 I/Os Port Map Control (P4) I/O Ports Interrupt and Wakeup SMCLK MCLK CPUXV2 and Working Registers 128KB 64KB Flash RAM LDO SVM,SVS Brownout P2.x P3.x PB P4.x P5.x PC P6.x PJ PJ.x P3 P4 P5 P6 1×5 I/Os 1×7 I/Os 1×6 I/Os 1×6 I/Os PB 1×12 I/Os PC 1×12 I/Os USCI0,1 PJ 1×4 I/Os USCI_Ax: UART, IrDA, SPI I/O Ports USCI_Bx: SPI, I2C MAB DMA MDB 3 Channel EEM (S: 3+1) ADC10_A JTAG, SBW Interface MPY32 TA0 TA1 TA2 TB0 Timer_A 5 CC Registers Timer_A 3 CC Registers Timer_A 3 CC Registers Timer_B 7 CC Registers RTC_A 10 Bit 200 KSPS CRC16 COMP_B REF 6 Channels 10 Channels (8 ext, 2 int) I/O are supplied by DVIO Figure 1-2. Functional Block Diagram – F5224, F5222 – RGZ Package Figure 1-3 shows the functional block diagram for the MSP430F5219 and MSP430F5217 devices in the RGC, ZQE, and YFF packages. XIN XOUT XT2IN XT2OUT Unified Clock System RSTDVCC RST/NMI BSLEN ACLK 8KB Power Management Flash RAM LDO SVM/SVS Brownout PA DVIO VCORE P1.x P2.x SYS P1 P1 P2 1×4 I/Os 1×4 I/Os 1×8 I/Os Watchdog PA 1×16 I/Os Port Map Control (P4) I/O Ports Interrupt and Wakeup SMCLK MCLK CPUXV2 and Working Registers 128KB 64KB DVCC AVCC DVSS AVSS P3.x PB P4.x P5.x PC P6.x PJ PD P7.x PJ.x P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 1×5 I/Os 1×8 I/Os 1×6 I/Os 1×8 I/Os 1×6 I/Os PB 1×13 I/Os PC 1×14 I/Os USCI0,1 PD PJ 1×6 I/Os 1×4 I/Os I/O Ports USCI_Ax: UART, IrDA, SPI USCI_Bx: SPI, I2C MAB DMA MDB 3 Channel EEM (S: 3+1) JTAG, SBW Interface MPY32 TA0 TA1 TA2 TB0 Timer_A 5 CC Registers Timer_A 3 CC Registers Timer_A 3 CC Registers Timer_B 7 CC Registers COMP_B RTC_A CRC16 REF 8 Channels I/O are supplied by DVIO Figure 1-3. Functional Block Diagram – F5219, F5217 – RGC, ZQE, YFF Packages 4 Device Overview Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Figure 1-4 shows the functional block diagram for the MSP430F5214 and MSP430F5212 devices in the RGZ package. XIN XOUT XT2IN XT2OUT Unified Clock System RSTDVCC RST/NMI BSLEN ACLK 8KB Power Management Flash RAM LDO SVM, SVS Brownout PA DVIO VCORE P1.x P2.x SYS P1 P1 P2 1×4 I/Os 1×4 I/Os 1×1 I/Os Watchdog PA 1×9 I/Os Port Map Control (P4) I/O Ports Interrupt and Wakeup SMCLK MCLK CPUXV2 and Working Registers 128KB 64KB DVCC AVCC DVSS AVSS P3.x PB P4.x P5.x PC P6.x PJ PJ.x P3 P4 P5 P6 1×5 I/Os 1×7 I/Os 1×6 I/Os 1×6 I/Os PB 1×12 I/Os PC 1×12 I/Os USCI0,1 PJ 1×4 I/Os USCI_Ax: UART, IrDA, SPI I/O Ports USCI_Bx: SPI, I2C MAB DMA MDB 3 Channel EEM (S: 3+1) JTAG, SBW Interface TA1 TA2 TB0 Timer_A 3 CC Registers Timer_A 3 CC Registers Timer_B 7 CC Registers TA0 MPY32 Timer_A 5 CC Registers COMP_B RTC_A CRC16 REF 6 Channels I/O are supplied by DVIO Figure 1-4. Functional Block Diagram – F5214, F5212 – RGZ Package Device Overview Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 5 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table of Contents 1 2 3 4 5 Device Overview ......................................... 1 1.1 Features .............................................. 1 1.2 Applications ........................................... 2 1.3 Description ............................................ 2 1.4 Functional Block Diagrams ........................... 3 5.20 Revision History ......................................... 7 Device Comparison ..................................... 8 Terminal Configuration and Functions .............. 9 4.1 Pin Diagrams ......................................... 9 4.2 Signal Descriptions .................................. 15 5.21 Crystal Oscillator, XT1, Low-Frequency Mode ...... 32 5.22 5.23 Crystal Oscillator, XT2 .............................. 33 Internal Very-Low-Power Low-Frequency Oscillator (VLO) ................................................ 34 Internal Reference, Low-Frequency Oscillator (REFO) .............................................. 34 5.24 Specifications ........................................... 20 5.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ......................... 20 5.25 DCO Frequency ..................................... 35 5.2 ESD Ratings ........................................ Recommended Operating Conditions ............... 5.26 PMM, Brown-Out Reset (BOR) 5.27 PMM, Core Voltage ................................. 36 5.28 PMM, SVS High Side 5.29 PMM, SVM High Side ............................... 38 5.30 PMM, SVS Low Side ................................ 38 5.31 5.32 PMM, SVM Low Side ............................... 39 Wake-up Times From Low-Power Modes and Reset ................................................ 39 5.33 Timer_A 5.34 5.35 Timer_B ............................................. 40 USCI (UART Mode), Recommended Operating Conditions ........................................... 41 5.36 5.37 USCI (UART Mode) ................................. 41 USCI (SPI Master Mode), Recommended Operating Conditions ........................................... 41 5.38 USCI (SPI Master Mode)............................ 41 5.39 USCI (SPI Slave Mode) ............................. 43 5.40 5.41 USCI (I2C Mode) .................................... 45 10-Bit ADC, Power Supply and Input Range Conditions ........................................... 46 5.42 10-Bit ADC, Timing Parameters 5.43 10-Bit ADC, Linearity Parameters................... 47 5.44 REF, External Reference 5.45 REF, Built-In Reference ............................. 48 5.46 Comparator_B ....................................... 49 5.47 Flash Memory ....................................... 50 5.48 JTAG and Spy-Bi-Wire Interface .................... 50 5.49 DVIO BSL Entry ..................................... 51 5.3 5.4 20 20 Active Mode Supply Current Into VCC Excluding External Current ..................................... 23 Low-Power Mode Supply Currents (Into VCC) Excluding External Current.......................... 24 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 5.9 5.10 5.11 5.12 5.13 5.14 5.15 5.16 5.17 5.18 6 5.19 (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5) .................................. 29 Typical Characteristics – Outputs, Reduced Drive Strength (PxDS.y = 0) ............................... 30 Typical Characteristics – Outputs, Full Drive Strength (PxDS.y = 1) ............................... 31 Thermal Characteristics ............................ 25 Schmitt-Trigger Inputs – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3, RSTDVCC) ................................... 26 Schmitt-Trigger Inputs – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5, RST/NMI, BSLEN) ............. 26 Inputs – Interrupts DVCC Domain Port P1 (P1.0 to P1.3) ....................................... 26 Inputs – Interrupts DVIO Domain Ports P1 and P2 (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7)......................... 26 Leakage Current – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3) ................................................. 27 Leakage Current – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5) .................................. 27 Outputs – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (Full Drive Strength) (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3) ................................................. 27 Outputs – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (Reduced Drive Strength) (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3) ................................................. 27 Outputs – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain (Full Drive Strength) (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5) .................................. 28 Outputs – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain (Reduced Drive Strength) (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5) .................................. 28 Output Frequency – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3) ................................................. 29 Output Frequency – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain Table of Contents 6 7 ..................... ............................... ............................................. .................... ........................... 36 37 40 46 47 Detailed Description ................................... 52 6.1 CPU (Link to user's guide) .......................... 52 6.2 Operating Modes .................................... 53 6.3 Interrupt Vector Addresses.......................... 54 6.4 Memory Organization ............................... 55 6.5 Bootstrap Loader (BSL) ............................. 57 6.6 JTAG Operation ..................................... 58 6.7 Flash Memory (Link to user's guide) ................ 59 6.8 RAM (Link to user's guide) .......................... 59 .......................................... 6.9 Peripherals 6.10 Input/Output Schematics ............................ 81 60 6.11 Device Descriptors .................................. 97 Device and Documentation Support .............. 103 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 7.1 Device Support..................................... 103 7.6 Electrostatic Discharge Caution 7.2 Documentation Support ............................ 106 7.7 Export Control Notice .............................. 107 7.3 Related Links 7.8 Glossary............................................ 107 7.4 Community Resources............................. 107 7.5 Trademarks ........................................ 107 ...................................... 106 8 ................... 107 Mechanical, Packaging, and Orderable Information ............................................. 107 2 Revision History NOTE: Page numbers for previous revisions may differ from page numbers in the current version. Changes from Revision E (May 2014) to Revision F • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Page Added Section 1.4 and moved all functional block diagrams to it .............................................................. 3 Added shading in Figure 4-1 to show P7.0 to P7.5 on DVIO power rail ...................................................... 9 Added shading in Figure 4-3 to show P7.0 to P7.5 on DVIO power rail ..................................................... 11 Added shading in Figure 4-5 to show P7.0 to P7.5 on DVIO power rail ..................................................... 13 Figure 4-6, 64-Pin YFF Package – F5229, F5227, F5219, F5217: changed all pin assignments (rotated signal names 90° relative to pin names); added shading on P7.0 to P7.5 to indicate DVIO power rail ......................... 14 Removed YFF package dimensions (refer to mechanical data in Section 8) .............................................. 14 Changed all pin numbers for the YFF package in Table 4-1, Terminal Functions ......................................... 15 Corrected Supply column for P7.0 to P7.5 (changed from DVCC to DVIO) ................................................ 18 Added Section 5.2, ESD Ratings.................................................................................................. 20 Added second note "Under certain condtions during the rising transition..." on Figure 5-1 ............................... 21 Added Section 5.6, Thermal Characteristics .................................................................................... 25 Updated Test Conditions for all parameters in Section 5.43, 10-Bit ADC, Linearity Parameters: removed "VREF–"; changed from "CVREF+ = 20 pF" to "CVeREF+ = 20 pF"; changed from "(VeREF+ – VeREF–)min ≤ (VeREF+ – VeREF–)" to "1.4 V ≤ (VeREF+ – VeREF–)" .......................................................................................................... 47 Added "CVeREF+ = 20 pF" to EI Test Conditions.................................................................................. 47 Added "ADC10SREFx = 11b" to Test Conditions for EG and ET .............................................................. 47 Removed "VREF–" from Test Conditions for VeREF+, VeREF–, and (VeREF+ – VeREF–) parameters in Section 5.44, REF, External Reference ........................................................................................................... 47 Corrected spelling of MRG bits in fMCLK,MRG parameter symbol and description ............................................ 50 Changed all YFF pin numbers in Table 6-11, TA0 Signal Connections ..................................................... 66 Changed all YFF pin numbers in Table 6-12, TA1 Signal Connections ..................................................... 67 Changed all YFF pin numbers in Table 6-13, TA2 Signal Connections ..................................................... 68 Changed all YFF pin numbers in Table 6-14, TB0 Signal Connections ..................................................... 69 Changed P5.3 schematic (added P5SEL.2 and XT2BYPASS inputs with AND and OR gates) ......................... 89 Changed P5SEL.3 column from X to 0 for "P5.3 (I/O)" rows .................................................................. 89 Changed P5.5 schematic (added P5SEL.5 input and OR gate) .............................................................. 91 Changed P5SEL.5 column from X to 0 for "P5.5 (I/O)" rows .................................................................. 91 Revision History Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 7 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 3 Device Comparison Table 3-1 summarizes the available family members. Table 3-1. Family Members (1) (2) USCI DEVICE FLASH (KB) SRAM (KB) Timer_A (3) Timer_B (4) ADC10_A (Ch) Comp_B (Ch) I/O DVCC (5) I/O DVIO (6) PACKAGE MSP430F5229 128 8 5, 3, 3 7 2 2 10 ext, 2 int 8 22 31 64 RGC 64 YFF 80 ZQE MSP430F5227 64 8 5, 3, 3 7 2 2 10 ext, 2 int 8 22 31 64 RGC 64 YFF 80 ZQE MSP430F5224 128 8 5, 3, 3 MSP430F5222 64 8 5, 3, 3 7 2 2 8 ext, 2 int 6 20 17 48 RGZ 7 2 2 8 ext, 2 int 6 20 17 48 RGZ CHANNEL A: CHANNEL B: UART, IrDA, SPI, I2C SPI MSP430F5219 128 8 5, 3, 3 7 2 2 - 8 22 31 64 RGC 64 YFF 80 ZQE MSP430F5217 64 8 5, 3, 3 7 2 2 - 8 22 31 64 RGC 64 YFF 80 ZQE MSP430F5214 128 8 5, 3, 3 7 2 2 - 6 20 17 48 RGZ MSP430F5212 64 8 5, 3, 3 7 2 2 - 6 20 17 48 RGZ (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) 8 For the most current device, package, and ordering information, see the Package Option Addendum in Section 8, or see the TI website at www.ti.com. Package drawings, standard packing quantities, thermal data, symbolization, and PCB design guidelines are available at www.ti.com/packaging. Each number in the sequence represents an instantiation of Timer_A with its associated number of capture compare registers and PWM output generators available. For example, a number sequence of 3, 5 would represent two instantiations of Timer_A, the first instantiation having 3 and the second instantiation having 5 capture compare registers and PWM output generators, respectively. Each number in the sequence represents an instantiation of Timer_B with its associated number of capture compare registers and PWM output generators available. For example, a number sequence of 3, 5 would represent two instantiations of Timer_B, the first instantiation having 3 and the second instantiation having 5 capture compare registers and PWM output generators, respectively. All of these I/Os reside on a single voltage rail supplied by DVCC. All of these I/Os reside on a single voltage rail supplied by DVIO. Device Comparison Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 4 Terminal Configuration and Functions 4.1 Pin Diagrams P7.0/TB0.0 P7.1/TB0.1 P7.2/TB0.2 P7.3/TB0.3 P7.4/TB0.4 P7.5/TB0.5 BSLEN RST/NMI P5.2/XT2IN P5.3/XT2OUT TEST/SBWTCK PJ.0/TDO PJ.1/TDI/TCLK PJ.2/TMS RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO PJ.3/TCK Figure 4-1 shows the pinout for the MSP430F5229 and MSP430F5227 devices in the 64-pin RGC package. 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 P6.0/A0/CB0 1 48 P4.7/PM_NONE P6.1/A1/CB1 2 47 P4.6/PM_NONE P6.2/A2/CB2 3 46 P4.5/PM_UCA1RXD/PM_UCA1SOMI P6.3/A3/CB3 4 45 P4.4/PM_UCA1TXD/PM_UCA1SIMO P6.4/A4/CB4 5 44 P4.3/PM_UCB1CLK/PM_UCA1STE P6.5/A5/CB5 6 43 P4.2/PM_UCB1SOMI/PM_UCB1SCL P6.6/A6/CB6 7 42 P4.1/PM_UCB1SIMO/PM_UCB1SDA MSP430F5229IRGC 41 P4.0/PM_UCB1STE/PM_UCA1CLK MSP430F5227IRGC 40 DVIO 36 P3.2/UCB0CLK/UCA0STE 14 35 P3.1/UCB0SOMI/UCB0SCL DVCC 15 34 P3.0/UCB0SIMO/UCB0SDA DVSS 33 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 P2.7/UCB0STE/UCA0CLK P2.6/RTCCLK/DMAE0 P2.5/TA2.2 13 AVSS P2.4/TA2.1 P5.5/XOUT P2.3/TA2.0 P3.3/UCA0TXD/UCA0SIMO P2.1/TA1.2 37 P2.2/TA2CLK/SMCLK 12 P2.0/TA1.1 P5.4/XIN P1.7/TA1.0 P3.4/UCA0RXD/UCA0SOMI P1.6/TA1CLK/CBOUT 38 P1.5/TA0.4 DVSS 11 P1.4/TA0.3 39 AVCC P1.3/TA0.2 10 P1.2/TA0.1 P5.1/A9/VeREF- P1.1/TA0.0 9 VCORE 8 P1.0/TA0CLK/ACLK P6.7/A7/CB7 P5.0/A8/VeREF+ Supplied by DVIO NOTE: TI recommends connection of exposed thermal pad to VSS. Figure 4-1. 64-Pin RGC Package – F5229, F5227 Terminal Configuration and Functions Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 9 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com P5.2/XT2IN RST/NMI P5.3/XT2OUT TEST/SBWTCK PJ.0/TDO PJ.1/TDI/TCLK PJ.2/TMS PJ.3/TCK RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO P6.0/A0/CB0 P6.1/A1/CB1 P6.2/A2/CB2 Figure 4-2 shows the pinout for the MSP430F5224 and MSP430F5222 devices in the 48-pin RGZ package. 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 P6.3/A3/CB3 1 36 BSLEN P6.4/A4/CB4 2 35 P4.6/PM_NONE P6.5/A5/CB5 3 34 P4.5/PM_UCA1RXD/PM_UCA1SOMI P5.0/A8/VeREF+ 4 33 P4.4/PM_UCA1TXD/PM_UCA1SIMO P5.1/A9/VeREF- 5 32 P4.3/PM_UCB1CLK/PM_UCA1STE AVCC 6 MSP430F5224IRGZ 31 P4.2/PM_UCB1SOMI/PM_UCB1SCL MSP430F5222IRGZ 27 DVSS 11 26 P3.4/UCA0RXD/UCA0SOMI 25 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 P3.3/UCA0TXD/UCA0SIMO P1.0/TA0CLK/ACLK VCORE Supplied by DVIO P3.2/UCB0CLK/UCA0STE 10 DVSS P3.1/UCB0SOMI/UCB0SCL DVCC P2.7/UCB0STE/UCA0CLK DVIO P3.0/UCB0SIMO/UCB0SDA 28 P1.7/TA1.0 9 P1.5/TA0.4 AVSS P1.6/TA1CLK/CBOUT P4.0/PM_UCB1STE/PM_UCA1CLK P1.4/TA0.3 P4.1/PM_UCB1SIMO/PM_UCB1SDA 29 P1.3/TA0.2 30 8 P1.2/TA0.1 7 P1.1/TA0.0 P5.4/XIN P5.5/XOUT NOTE: TI recommends connection of exposed thermal pad to VSS. Figure 4-2. 48-Pin RGZ Package – F5224, F5222 10 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 P7.0/TB0.0 P7.1/TB0.1 P7.2/TB0.2 P7.3/TB0.3 P7.4/TB0.4 P7.5/TB0.5 BSLEN RST/NMI P5.2/XT2IN P5.3/XT2OUT TEST/SBWTCK PJ.0/TDO PJ.1/TDI/TCLK PJ.2/TMS PJ.3/TCK RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO Figure 4-3 shows the pinout for the MSP430F5219 and MSP430F5217 devices in the 64-pin RGC package. 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 P6.0/CB0 1 48 P4.7/PM_NONE P6.1/CB1 2 47 P4.6/PM_NONE P6.2/CB2 3 46 P4.5/PM_UCA1RXD/PM_UCA1SOMI P6.3/CB3 4 45 P4.4/PM_UCA1TXD/PM_UCA1SIMO P6.4/CB4 5 44 P4.3/PM_UCB1CLK/PM_UCA1STE P6.5/CB5 6 43 P4.2/PM_UCB1SOMI/PM_UCB1SCL P6.6/CB6 7 42 P4.1/PM_UCB1SIMO/PM_UCB1SDA P6.7/CB7 8 MSP430F5219IRGC 41 P4.0/PM_UCB1STE/PM_UCA1CLK P5.0 9 MSP430F5217IRGC 40 DVIO P5.1 10 39 DVSS AVCC 11 38 P3.4/UCA0RXD/UCA0SOMI P2.7/UCB0STE/UCA0CLK P2.6/RTCCLK/DMAE0 P2.5/TA2.2 P2.4/TA2.1 P2.3/TA2.0 P3.0/UCB0SIMO/UCB0SDA P2.1/TA1.2 34 33 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 P2.2/TA2CLK/SMCLK 15 DVSS P2.0/TA1.1 DVCC P1.7/TA1.0 P3.1/UCB0SOMI/UCB0SCL P1.6/TA1CLK/CBOUT 35 P1.5/TA0.4 14 P1.4/TA0.3 AVSS P1.3/TA0.2 P3.2/UCB0CLK/UCA0STE P1.2/TA0.1 P3.3/UCA0TXD/UCA0SIMO 36 P1.1/TA0.0 37 13 VCORE 12 P1.0/TA0CLK/ACLK P5.4/XIN P5.5/XOUT Supplied by DVIO NOTE: TI recommends connection of exposed thermal pad to VSS. Figure 4-3. 64-Pin RGC Package – F5219, F5217 Terminal Configuration and Functions Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 11 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com RST/NMI P5.2/XT2IN P5.3/XT2OUT TEST/SBWTCK PJ.0/TDO PJ.1/TDI/TCLK PJ.2/TMS PJ.3/TCK RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO P6.0/CB0 P6.1/CB1 P6.2/CB2 Figure 4-4 shows the pinout for the MSP430F5214 and MSP430F5212 devices in the 48-pin RGZ package. 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 P6.3/CB3 1 36 BSLEN P6.4/CB4 2 35 P4.6/PM_NONE P6.5/CB5 3 34 P4.5/PM_UCA1RXD/PM_UCA1SOMI P5.0 4 33 P4.4/PM_UCA1TXD/PM_UCA1SIMO P5.1 5 32 P4.3/PM_UCB1CLK/PM_UCA1STE AVCC 6 MSP430F5214IRGZ 31 P4.2/PM_UCB1SOMI/PM_UCB1SCL MSP430F5212IRGZ 27 DVSS 11 26 P3.4/UCA0RXD/UCA0SOMI 12 25 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 P3.3/UCA0TXD/UCA0SIMO P1.0/TA0CLK/ACLK VCORE Supplied by DVIO P3.2/UCB0CLK/UCA0STE 10 DVSS P3.1/UCB0SOMI/UCB0SCL DVCC P2.7/UCB0STE/UCA0CLK DVIO P3.0/UCB0SIMO/UCB0SDA 28 P1.7/TA1.0 9 P1.5/TA0.4 AVSS P1.6/TA1CLK/CBOUT P4.0/PM_UCB1STE/PM_UCA1CLK P1.4/TA0.3 P4.1/PM_UCB1SIMO/PM_UCB1SDA 29 P1.3/TA0.2 30 8 P1.2/TA0.1 7 P1.1/TA0.0 P5.4/XIN P5.5/XOUT NOTE: TI recommends connection of exposed thermal pad to VSS. Figure 4-4. 48-Pin RGZ Package – F5214, F5212 12 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Figure 4-5 shows the pinout for the MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5219, and MSP430F5217 devices in the 80-pin ZQE package. TEST RST/NMI P7.5 P7.4 P7.3 P7.1 A4 A5 A7 A8 A9 PJ.3 P5.3 P5.2 B3 B4 B5 P6.3 PJ.1 PJ.0 C2 C4 C5 C6 D4 D5 D6 P6.0 RSTDVCC PJ.2 A1 A2 A3 P6.2 P6.1 B1 B2 P6.4 C1 P6.6 P6.5 P6.7 D1 D2 D3 P5.0 P5.1 E1 E2 P5.4 AVCC F1 F2 P5.5 AVSS G1 G2 G3 DVCC P1.0 H1 H2 J2 BSLEN P7.2 B6 P7.0 B7 B8 B9 P4.7 P4.6 P4.5 C7 C8 C9 P4.4 P4.3 P4.2 D7 D8 D9 P4.1 P4.0 DVIO E3 E4 E5 E6 E7 E8 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 E9 F9 P1.3 P1.6 P2.1 P3.4 P3.2 P3.3 G4 G5 G6 G7 G8 G9 P1.1 P1.4 P1.7 P2.3 P2.7 P3.0 P3.1 H3 H4 H5 H6 H7 H8 H9 P1.5 P2.0 P2.2 P2.4 P2.5 P2.6 J4 J5 J6 J7 J8 J9 DVSS DVSS VCORE P1.2 J1 A6 J3 Supplied by DVIO Figure 4-5. 80-Pin ZQE Package – F5229, F5227, F5219, F5217 Terminal Configuration and Functions Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 13 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Figure 4-6 shows the pinout for the MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5219, and MSP430F5217 devices in the 64-pin YFF package. Top View D Ball-Side View H8 H7 H6 H5 H4 H3 H2 H1 H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 H6 H7 H8 P7.0 P7.3 P7.5 P5.2 P5.3 PJ.1 PJ.3 P6.1 P6.1 PJ.3 PJ.1 P5.3 P5.2 P7.5 P7.3 P7.0 G6 G5 G4 G4 G5 G6 G8 G7 P4.6 P7.1 F8 F7 P4.4 P4.7 P7.4 BSLEN PJ.0 F5 G3 G2 G1 G1 G2 G3 P6.0 P6.2 P6.4 P6.4 P6.2 P6.0 F3 F2 F1 F1 F2 F3 P7.2 RST/NMI PJ.2 P6.3 P6.5 P6.7 P6.7 P6.5 P6.3 E5 E3 F6 E8 E7 E6 P4.1 P4.3 P4.5 F4 E4 TEST RSTDVCC P6.6 E2 E1 P5.0 P5.1 D E1 E2 P5.1 P5.0 E3 PJ.0 BSLEN P7.4 F5 F4 F6 PJ.2 RST/NMI P7.2 E5 E4 P6.6 RSTDVCC TEST G7 G8 P7.1 P4.6 F7 F8 P4.7 P4.4 E6 E7 E8 P4.5 P4.3 P4.1 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 DVIO P3.4 P4.0 P4.2 P2.1 P1.4 AVCC P5.4 P5.4 AVCC P1.4 P2.1 P4.2 P4.0 P3.4 DVIO C8 C7 C6 C5 C4 C3 C2 C1 C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 C8 DVSS P3.2 P2.7 P2.4 P1.7 P1.3 AVSS P5.5 P5.5 AVSS P1.3 P1.7 P2.4 P2.7 P3.2 DVSS B8 B7 B6 B5 B4 B3 B2 B1 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B8 P3.3 P3.1 P2.5 P2.2 P1.6 P1.1 P1.0 DVCC DVCC P1.0 P1.1 P1.6 P2.2 P2.5 P3.1 P3.3 A3 A2 A1 A1 A2 A3 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 P3.0 P2.6 P2.3 P2.0 P1.5 P1.2 VCORE DVSS E DVSS VCORE P1.2 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 P1.5 P2.0 P2.3 P2.6 P3.0 E Supplied by DVIO Figure 4-6. 64-Pin YFF Package – F5229, F5227, F5219, F5217 14 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com 4.2 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Signal Descriptions Table 4-1 describes the signals for all device variants and package options. Table 4-1. Terminal Functions TERMINAL NAME NO. RGC ZQE YFF RGZ 5 C1 G1 2 I/O (1) SUPPLY I/O DVCC DESCRIPTION General-purpose digital I/O P6.4/CB4/A4 Comparator_B input CB4 Analog input A4 for ADC (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O P6.5/CB5/A5 6 D2 F2 3 I/O DVCC Comparator_B input CB5 Analog input A5 for ADC (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O (not available on all device types) P6.6/CB6/A6 7 D1 E3 N/A I/O DVCC Comparator_B input CB6 (not available on all device types) Analog input A6 for ADC (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O (not available on all device types) P6.7/CB7/A7 8 D3 F1 N/A I/O DVCC Comparator_B input CB7 (not available on all device types) Analog input A7 for ADC (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O P5.0/A8/VeREF+ 9 E1 E2 4 I/O DVCC Analog input A8 for ADC (not available on all device types) Input for an external reference voltage to the ADC (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O Analog input A9 for ADC (not available on all device types) P5.1/A9/VeREF- 10 E2 E1 5 I/O DVCC AVCC 11 F2 D2 6 P5.4/XIN 12 F1 D1 7 I/O DVCC P5.5/XOUT 13 G1 C1 8 I/O DVCC AVSS 14 G2 C2 9 Analog ground supply DVCC 15 H1 B1 10 Digital power supply DVSS 16 J1 A1 11 Digital ground supply VCORE (3) 17 J2 A2 12 P1.0/TA0CLK/ACLK 18 H2 B2 13 Negative terminal for the ADC's reference voltage for an external applied reference voltage (not available on all device types) Analog power supply DVCC General-purpose digital I/O Input terminal for crystal oscillator XT1 (2) General-purpose digital I/O Output terminal of crystal oscillator XT1 Regulated core power supply output (internal use only, no external current loading) General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt I/O DVCC TA0 clock signal TA0CLK input ACLK output (divided by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, or 32) General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt P1.1/TA0.0 19 H3 B3 14 I/O DVCC TA0 CCR0 capture: CCI0A input, compare: Out0 output BSL transmit output General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt P1.2/TA0.1 20 J3 A3 15 I/O DVCC TA0 CCR1 capture: CCI1A input, compare: Out1 output BSL receive input (1) (2) (3) I = input, O = output, N/A = not available When in crystal bypass mode, XIN can be configured so that it can support an input digital waveform with swing levels from DVSS to DVCC or DVSS to DVIO. In this case, it is required that the pin be configured properly for the intended input swing. VCORE is for internal use only. No external current loading is possible. VCORE should only be connected to the recommended capacitor value, CVCORE. Terminal Configuration and Functions Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 15 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Terminal Functions (continued) TERMINAL NAME NO. I/O (1) SUPPLY RGC ZQE YFF RGZ P1.3/TA0.2 21 G4 C3 16 I/O DVCC P1.4/TA0.3 22 H4 D3 17 I/O DVIO (4) P1.5/TA0.4 23 J4 A4 18 I/O DVIO (4) P1.6/TA1CLK/CBOUT 24 G5 B4 19 I/O DVIO (4) DESCRIPTION General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt TA0 CCR2 capture: CCI2A input, compare: Out2 output General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt TA0 CCR3 capture: CCI3A input compare: Out3 output General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt TA0 CCR4 capture: CCI4A input, compare: Out4 output General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt TA1 clock signal TA1CLK input Comparator_B output P1.7/TA1.0 P2.0/TA1.1 P2.1/TA1.2 P2.2/TA2CLK/SMCLK 25 26 27 28 H5 J5 G6 J6 C4 A5 D4 B5 20 N/A N/A N/A I/O DVIO (4) I/O (4) DVIO TA1 CCR0 capture: CCI0A input, compare: Out0 output General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt (not available on all device types) TA1 CCR1 capture: CCI1A input, compare: Out1 output (not available on all device types) I/O DVIO (4) I/O (4) DVIO General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt (not available on all device types) TA1 CCR2 capture: CCI2A input, compare: Out2 output (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt (not available on all device types) TA2 clock signal TA2CLK input SMCLK output (not available on all device types) P2.3/TA2.0 P2.4/TA2.1 P2.5/TA2.2 29 30 31 H6 J7 J8 A6 C5 B6 N/A N/A N/A I/O I/O I/O DVIO (4) DVIO (4) DVIO (4) General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt (not available on all device types) TA2 CCR0 capture: CCI0A input, compare: Out0 output (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt (not available on all device types) TA2 CCR1 capture: CCI1A input, compare: Out1 output (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt (not available on all device types) TA2 CCR2 capture: CCI2A input, compare: Out2 output (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O with port interrupt (not available on all device types) P2.6/RTCCLK/DMAE0 32 J9 A7 N/A I/O DVIO (4) RTC clock output for calibration (not available on all device types) DMA external trigger input (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O P2.7/UCB0STE/ UCA0CLK 33 P3.0/UCB0SIMO/ UCB0SDA 34 H7 C6 21 I/O DVIO (4) Slave transmit enable – USCI_B0 SPI mode Clock signal input – USCI_A0 SPI slave mode Clock signal output – USCI_A0 SPI master mode General-purpose digital I/O (4) 16 H8 A8 22 I/O DVIO (4) Slave in, master out – USCI_B0 SPI mode I2C data – USCI_B0 I2C mode This pin function is supplied by DVIO. See Section 5.8 for input and output requirements. Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 4-1. Terminal Functions (continued) TERMINAL NAME NO. RGC ZQE YFF RGZ 35 H9 B7 23 I/O (1) SUPPLY I/O DVIO (4) DESCRIPTION General-purpose digital I/O P3.1/UCB0SOMI/ UCB0SCL Slave out, master in – USCI_B0 SPI mode I2C clock – USCI_B0 I2C mode General-purpose digital I/O P3.2/UCB0CLK/ UCA0STE 36 G8 C7 24 I/O DVIO (4) Clock signal input – USCI_B0 SPI slave mode Clock signal output – USCI_B0 SPI master mode Slave transmit enable – USCI_A0 SPI mode General-purpose digital I/O P3.3/UCA0TXD/ UCA0SIMO 37 G9 B8 25 I/O DVIO (4) Transmit data – USCI_A0 UART mode Slave in, master out – USCI_A0 SPI mode General-purpose digital I/O P3.4/UCA0RXD/ UCA0SOMI 38 G7 D7 26 DVSS 39 F9 C8 27 Digital ground supply DVIO (5) 40 E9 D8 28 Digital I/O power supply I/O DVIO (4) Receive data – USCI_A0 UART mode Slave out, master in – USCI_A0 SPI mode General-purpose digital I/O with reconfigurable port mapping secondary function P4.0/PM_UCB1STE/ PM_UCA1CLK P4.1/PM_UCB1SIMO/ PM_UCB1SDA 41 E8 D6 29 I/O DVIO (4) Default mapping: Slave transmit enable – USCI_B1 SPI mode Default mapping: Clock signal input – USCI_A1 SPI slave mode Default mapping: Clock signal output – USCI_A1 SPI master mode 42 E7 E8 30 I/O DVIO (4) General-purpose digital I/O with reconfigurable port mapping secondary function Default mapping: Slave in, master out – USCI_B1 SPI mode Default mapping: I2C data – USCI_B1 I2C mode P4.2/PM_UCB1SOMI/ PM_UCB1SCL 43 D9 D5 31 I/O DVIO (4) General-purpose digital I/O with reconfigurable port mapping secondary function Default mapping: Slave out, master in – USCI_B1 SPI mode Default mapping: I2C clock – USCI_B1 I2C mode General-purpose digital I/O with reconfigurable port mapping secondary function P4.3/PM_UCB1CLK/ PM_UCA1STE 44 D8 E7 32 I/O DVIO (4) Default mapping: Clock signal input – USCI_B1 SPI slave mode Default mapping: Clock signal output – USCI_B1 SPI master mode Default mapping: Slave transmit enable – USCI_A1 SPI mode P4.4/PM_UCA1TXD/ PM_UCA1SIMO 45 D7 F8 33 I/O DVIO (4) General-purpose digital I/O with reconfigurable port mapping secondary function Default mapping: Transmit data – USCI_A1 UART mode Default mapping: Slave in, master out – USCI_A1 SPI mode P4.5/PM_UCA1RXD/ PM_UCA1SOMI 46 C9 E6 34 I/O DVIO (4) General-purpose digital I/O with reconfigurable port mapping secondary function Default mapping: Receive data – USCI_A1 UART mode Default mapping: Slave out, master in – USCI_A1 SPI mode P4.6/PM_NONE 47 C8 G8 35 I/O DVIO (4) General-purpose digital I/O with reconfigurable port mapping secondary function Default mapping: no secondary function (5) The voltage on DVIO is not supervised or monitored. Terminal Configuration and Functions Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 17 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 4-1. Terminal Functions (continued) TERMINAL NAME I/O (1) NO. RGC ZQE YFF SUPPLY DESCRIPTION RGZ (4) General-purpose digital I/O with reconfigurable port mapping secondary function (not available on all device types) P4.7/PM_NONE 48 C7 F7 N/A I/O DVIO P7.0/TB0.0 49 B8, B9 H8 N/A I/O DVIO (4) P7.1/TB0.1 50 A9 G7 N/A I/O DVIO (4) P7.2/TB0.2 51 B7 F6 N/A I/O DVIO (4) P7.3/TB0.3 52 A8 H7 N/A I/O DVIO (4) P7.4/TB0.4 53 A7 G6 N/A I/O DVIO (4) P7.5/TB0.5 54 A6 H6 N/A I/O DVIO (4) TB0 CCR5 capture: CCI5A input, compare: Out5 output (not available on all device types) BSLEN 55 B6 G5 36 I DVIO (4) BSL enable with internal pulldown RST/NMI 56 A5 F5 37 I DVIO (4) P5.2/XT2IN 57 B5 H5 38 I/O DVCC P5.3/XT2OUT 58 B4 H4 39 I/O DVCC TEST/SBWTCK (9) 59 A4 E5 40 I DVCC PJ.0/TDO (10) 60 C5 G4 41 I/O DVCC PJ.1/TDI/TCLK (10) 61 C4 H3 42 I/O DVCC PJ.2/TMS (10) 62 A3 F4 43 I/O DVCC PJ.3/TCK (10) 63 B3 H2 44 I/O DVCC Default mapping: no secondary function (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O (not available on all device types) TB0 CCR0 capture: CCI0A input, compare: Out0 output (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O (not available on all device types) TB0 CCR1 capture: CCI1A input, compare: Out1 output (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O (not available on all device types) TB0 CCR2 capture: CCI2A input, compare: Out2 output (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O (not available on all device types) TB0 CCR3 capture: CCI3A input, compare: Out3 output (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O (not available on all device types) TB0 CCR4 capture: CCI4A input, compare: Out4 output (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O (not available on all device types) Reset input active low (6) (7) Nonmaskable interrupt input (6) General-purpose digital I/O Input terminal for crystal oscillator XT2 (8) General-purpose digital I/O Output terminal of crystal oscillator XT2 Test mode pin – Selects four wire JTAG operation Spy-Bi-Wire input clock when Spy-Bi-Wire operation activated General-purpose digital I/O JTAG test data output port General-purpose digital I/O JTAG test data input or test clock input General-purpose digital I/O JTAG test mode select General-purpose digital I/O JTAG test clock (6) This pin is configurable as reset or NMI and resides on the DVIO supply domain. When driven from external, input swing levels from DVSS to DVIO are required. (7) When this pin is configured as reset, the internal pullup resistor is enabled by default. (8) When in crystal bypass mode, XT2IN can be configured so that it can support an input digital waveform with swing levels from DVSS to DVCC or DVSS to DVIO. In this case, it is required that the pin be configured properly for the intended input swing. (9) See Section 6.5 and Section 6.6 for use with BSL and JTAG functions. (10) See Section 6.6 for use with JTAG function. 18 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 4-1. Terminal Functions (continued) TERMINAL NAME I/O (1) NO. RGC ZQE YFF SUPPLY DESCRIPTION RGZ Reset input, active-low (11) RSTDVCC/ SBWTDIO (10) 64 A2 E4 45 I/O DVCC P6.0/CB0/A0 1 A1 G3 46 I/O DVCC Spy-Bi-Wire data input/output when Spy-Bi-Wire operation activated General-purpose digital I/O Comparator_B input CB0 Analog input A0 for ADC (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O P6.1/CB1/A1 2 B2 H1 47 I/O DVCC Comparator_B input CB1 Analog input A1 for ADC (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O P6.2/CB2/A2 3 B1 G2 48 I/O DVCC Comparator_B input CB2 Analog input A2 for ADC (not available on all device types) General-purpose digital I/O P6.3/CB3/A3 4 C2 F3 1 I/O DVCC Comparator_B input CB3 Analog input A3 for ADC (not available on all device types) Reserved N/A (12) N/A N/A Reserved QFN Pad Pad N/A N/A Pad QFN thermal pad. TI recommends connecting to VSS. (11) This nonconfigurable reset resides on the DVCC supply domain and has an internal pullup to DVCC. When driven from external, input swing levels from DVSS to DVCC are required. This reset must be used for Spy-Bi-Wire communication and is not the same RST/NMI reset as found on other devices in the MSP430 family. See Section 6.5 and Section 6.6 for details regarding the use of this pin. (12) C6, D4, D5, D6, E3, E4, E5, E6, F3, F4, F5, F6, F7, F8, G3 are reserved and should be connected to ground. Terminal Configuration and Functions Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 19 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5 Specifications Absolute Maximum Ratings (1) 5.1 over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted) MIN MAX Voltage applied at VCC to VSS –0.3 4.1 V Voltage applied at VIO to VSS –0.3 2.2 V Voltage applied to any pin (excluding VCORE and VIO pins) (2) –0.3 VCC + 0.3 V Voltage applied to VIO pins –0.3 VIO + 0.2 Diode current at any device pin Storage temperature, Tstg (3) (1) (2) (3) –55 UNIT V ±2 mA 150 °C Stresses beyond those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under Recommended Operating Conditions is not implied. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. All voltages referenced to VSS. VCORE is for internal device use only. No external DC loading or voltage should be applied. Higher temperature may be applied during board soldering according to the current JEDEC J-STD-020 specification with peak reflow temperatures not higher than classified on the device label on the shipping boxes or reels. 5.2 ESD Ratings VALUE V(ESD) (1) (2) 5.3 Electrostatic discharge Human-body model (HBM), per ANSI/ESDA/JEDEC JS-001 (1) UNIT ±1000 Charged-device model (CDM), per JEDEC specification JESD22-C101 (2) V ±250 JEDEC document JEP155 states that 500-V HBM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process. Pins listed as ±1000 V may actually have higher performance. JEDEC document JEP157 states that 250-V CDM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process. Pins listed as ±250 V may actually have higher performance. Recommended Operating Conditions Typical values are specified at VCC = 3.3 V and TA = 25°C (unless otherwise noted) MIN VCC Supply voltage during program execution and flash programming (AVCC = DVCC) (1) (2) (3) VIO Supply voltage applied to DVIO referenced to VSS (2) VSS Supply voltage (AVSS = DVSS) TA Operating free-air temperature TJ Operating junction temperature Recommended capacitor at VCORE CDVCC/ CVCORE Capacitor ratio of DVCC to VCORE (1) (2) (3) (4) 20 MAX 1.8 3.6 PMMCOREVx = 0, 1 2.0 3.6 PMMCOREVx = 0, 1, 2 2.2 3.6 PMMCOREVx = 0, 1, 2, 3 CVCORE NOM PMMCOREVx = 0 UNIT V 2.4 3.6 1.62 1.98 V –40 85 °C –40 85 °C 0 (4) V 470 nF 10 TI recommends powering AVCC and DVCC from the same source. A maximum difference of 0.3 V between AVCC and DVCC can be tolerated during power up and operation. During VCC and VIO power up, it is required that VIO ≥ VCC during the ramp up phase of VIO. During VCC and VIO power down, it is required that VIO ≥ VCC during the ramp down phase of VIO (see Figure 5-1). The minimum supply voltage is defined by the supervisor SVS levels when it is enabled. See the Section 5.28 threshold parameters for the exact values and further details. A capacitor tolerance of ±20% or better is required. Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Recommended Operating Conditions (continued) Typical values are specified at VCC = 3.3 V and TA = 25°C (unless otherwise noted) MIN fSYSTEM (5) Processor frequency (maximum MCLK frequency) (5) (see Figure 5-3) NOM MAX PMMCOREVx = 0 (default condition), 1.8 V ≤ VCC ≤ 3.6 V 0 8 PMMCOREVx = 1, 2.0 V ≤ VCC ≤ 3.6 V 0 12 PMMCOREVx = 2, 2.2 V ≤ VCC ≤ 3.6 V 0 20 PMMCOREVx = 3, 2.4 V ≤ VCC ≤ 3.6 V 0 25 UNIT MHz Modules may have a different maximum input clock specification. See the specification of the respective module in this data sheet. VCC VIO VIO,min VSS t VCC ≤ VIO while VIO < VIO,min VIO ≤ VCC VCC ≤ VIO while VIO < VIO,min NOTE: The device supports continuous operation with VCC = VSS while VIO is fully within its specification. During this time, the general-purpose I/Os that reside on the VIO supply domain are configured as inputs and pulled down to VSS through their internal pulldown resistors. RST/NMI is high impedance. BSLEN is configured as an input and is pulled down to VSS through its internal pulldown resistor. When VCC reaches above the BOR threshold, the general-purpose I/Os become high-impedance inputs (no pullup or pulldown enabled), RST/NMI becomes an input pulled up to VIO through its internal pullup resistor, and BSLEN remains pulled down to VSS through its internal pulldown resistor. NOTE: Under certain condtions during the rising transition of VCC, the general-purpose I/Os residing on the VIO supply domain may actively transition high momentarily before settling to high-impedance inputs. These voltage transitions are temporary (typically resolving to high-impedance inputs when VCC exceeds approximately 0.9 V) and are bounded by the VIO supply. Figure 5-1. VCC and VIO Power Sequencing Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 21 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com VCC V(SVSH_+), min tWAKE_UP_RESET tWAKE_UP_RESET DVCC tWAKE_UP_RESET VCC VIT+ RSTDVCC VCC ≥ VRSTDVCC VRSTDVCC = VCC VIO tWAKE_UP_RESET DVIO tWAKE_UP_RESET VIO VIT+ RST VIO ≥ VRST VRST = VIO t NOTE: The device remains in reset based on the conditions of the RSTDVCC and RST pins and the voltage present on DVCC voltage supply. If RSTDVCC or RST is held at a logic low or if DVCC is below the SVSH_+ minimum threshold, the device remains in its reset condition; that is, these conditions form a logical OR with respect to device reset. Figure 5-2. Reset Timing 22 Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 25 System Frequency - MHz 3 20 2 2, 3 1 1, 2 1, 2, 3 0, 1 0, 1, 2 0, 1, 2, 3 12 8 0 0 1.8 2.2 2.0 2.4 3.6 Supply Voltage - V The numbers within the fields denote the supported PMMCOREVx settings. Figure 5-3. Maximum System Frequency 5.4 Active Mode Supply Current Into VCC Excluding External Current over recommended operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (1) (2) (3) FREQUENCY (fDCO = fMCLK = fSMCLK) PARAMETER EXECUTION MEMORY VCC PMMCOREVx 1 MHz TYP IAM, IAM, (1) (2) (3) Flash RAM Flash RAM 3.0 V 3.0 V MAX 0.47 8 MHz TYP 2.32 MAX 12 MHz TYP 20 MHz MAX TYP 0 0.36 1 0.40 2.65 4.0 2 0.44 2.90 4.3 7.1 3 0.46 4.6 7.6 0 0.20 1 0.22 1.35 2.0 2 0.24 1.50 2.2 3.7 3 0.26 1.60 2.4 3.9 1.20 TYP UNIT MAX 2.60 3.10 0.29 25 MHz MAX 4.4 mA 7.7 10.1 11.0 1.30 2.2 mA 4.2 5.3 6.2 All inputs are tied to 0 V or to VCC. Outputs do not source or sink any current. The currents are characterized with a Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K crystal with a load capacitance of 12.5 pF. The internal and external load capacitance are chosen to closely match the required 12.5 pF. Characterized with program executing typical data processing. fACLK = 32786 Hz, fDCO = fMCLK = fSMCLK at specified frequency. XTS = CPUOFF = SCG0 = SCG1 = OSCOFF= SMCLKOFF = 0. Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 23 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.5 www.ti.com Low-Power Mode Supply Currents (Into VCC) Excluding External Current over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (1) (2) PARAMETER ILPM0,1MHz Low-power mode 0 (3) (4) ILPM2 Low-power mode 2 (5) (4) 85°C 0 73 77 91 80 85 97 3.0 V 3 79 83 99 88 95 107 2.2 V 0 6.5 6.5 12 10 11 17 3.0 V 3 7.0 7.0 13 11 12 18 0 1.60 1.90 2,8 6.0 1 1.65 2.00 3.0 6.3 2 1.75 2.15 3.2 6.6 0 1.8 2.1 3.0 6.2 1 1.9 2.3 3.2 6.5 2 2.0 2.4 3.3 6.8 3 2.0 2.5 3.9 3.4 6.8 10.9 0 1.1 1.4 2.7 2.0 6.1 9.7 1 1.1 1.4 2.2 6.4 2 1.2 1.5 2.3 6.8 3 1.3 1.6 3.0 2.3 6.8 10.9 0 0.9 1.1 1.5 2.0 5.1 8.8 1 1.1 1.2 2.1 5.3 2 1.2 1.2 2.2 5.5 3.0 V ILPM3,VLO 60°C 2.2 V Low-power mode 3, crystal mode (6) (4) Low-power mode 3, VLO mode (7) (4) 25°C PMMCOREVx 2.2 V ILPM3,XT1LF –40°C VCC 3.0 V TYP MAX TYP MAX 2.9 TYP MAX TYP MAX 9.4 Low-power mode 4 (8) (4) 3.0 V 1.3 1.3 1.6 2.2 5.5 9.8 ILPM4.5 Low-power mode 4.5 (9) 3.0 V 0.15 0.18 0.35 0.26 0.5 1.0 IDVIO_START Current supplied from DVIO while DVCC = AVCC = 0 V, DVIO = 1.62 V to 1.98 V, All DVIO I/O floating including BSLEN and RST/NMI 0V 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) 24 µA µA µA µA ILPM4 3 UNIT µA µA µA All inputs are tied to 0 V or to VCC. Outputs do not source or sink any current. The currents are characterized with a Micro Crystal MS1V-T1K crystal with a load capacitance of 12.5 pF. The internal and external load capacitance are chosen to closely match the required 12.5 pF. Current for the watchdog timer clocked by SMCLK included. ACLK = low-frequency crystal operation (XTS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 0). CPUOFF = 1, SCG0 = 0, SCG1 = 0, OSCOFF = 0 (LPM0), fACLK = 32768 Hz, fMCLK = 0 MHz, fSMCLK = fDCO = 1 MHz Current for brownout and high-side supervisor (SVSH) normal mode included. Low-side supervisor (SVSL) and low-side monitor (SVML) disabled. High-side monitor (SVMH) disabled. RAM retention enabled. Current for watchdog timer and RTC clocked by ACLK included. ACLK = low-frequency crystal operation (XTS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 0). CPUOFF = 1, SCG0 = 0, SCG1 = 1, OSCOFF = 0 (LPM2), fACLK = 32768 Hz, fMCLK = 0 MHz, fSMCLK = fDCO = 0 MHz; DCO setting = 1 MHz operation, DCO bias generator enabled.) Current for watchdog timer and RTC clocked by ACLK included. ACLK = low-frequency crystal operation (XTS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 0). CPUOFF = 1, SCG0 = 1, SCG1 = 1, OSCOFF = 0 (LPM3), fACLK = 32768 Hz, fMCLK = fSMCLK = fDCO = 0 MHz Current for watchdog timer and RTC clocked by ACLK included. ACLK = VLO. CPUOFF = 1, SCG0 = 1, SCG1 = 1, OSCOFF = 0 (LPM3), fACLK = fVLO, fMCLK = fSMCLK = fDCO = 0 MHz CPUOFF = 1, SCG0 = 1, SCG1 = 1, OSCOFF = 1 (LPM4), fDCO = fACLK = fMCLK = fSMCLK = 0 MHz Internal regulator disabled. No data retention. CPUOFF = 1, SCG0 = 1, SCG1 = 1, OSCOFF = 1, PMMREGOFF = 1 (LPM4.5), fDCO = fACLK = fMCLK = fSMCLK = 0 MHz Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com 5.6 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Thermal Characteristics VALUE (1) RθJA Junction-to-ambient thermal resistance, still air RθJC(TOP) Junction-to-case (top) thermal resistance RθJC(BOTTOM) RθJB ΨJT ΨJB (1) (2) Junction-to-case (bottom) thermal resistance Junction-to-board thermal resistance Junction-to-package-top thermal characterization parameter Junction-to-board thermal characterization parameter VQFN 48 (RGZ) 27.8 VQFN 64 (RGC) 29.6 DSBGA 64 (YFF) 44.3 BGA 80 (ZQE) 35.2 VQFN 48 (RGZ) 13.6 VQFN 64 (RGC) 14.8 DSBGA 64 (YFF) 0.2 BGA 80 (ZQE) 17.6 VQFN 48 (RGZ) 0.9 VQFN 64 (RGC) 1.4 DSBGA 64 (YFF) N/A (2) BGA 80 (ZQE) N/A VQFN 48 (RGZ) 4.7 VQFN 64 (RGC) 8.5 DSBGA 64 (YFF) 6.0 BGA 80 (ZQE) 16.7 VQFN 48 (RGZ) 0.2 VQFN 64 (RGC) 0.2 DSBGA 64 (YFF) 0.6 BGA 80 (ZQE) 0.3 VQFN 48 (RGZ) 4.7 VQFN 64 (RGC) 8.4 DSBGA 64 (YFF) 6.0 BGA 80 (ZQE) 9.6 UNIT °C/W °C/W °C/W °C/W °C/W °C/W These values are based on a JEDEC-defined 2S2P system (with the exception of the Theta JC [RθJC] value, which is based on a JEDEC-defined 1S0P system) and will change based on environment as well as application. For more information, see these EIA/JEDEC standards: • JESD51-2, Integrated Circuits Thermal Test Method Environmental Conditions - Natural Convection (Still Air) • JESD51-3, Low Effective Thermal Conductivity Test Board for Leaded Surface Mount Packages • JESD51-7, High Effective Thermal Conductivity Test Board for Leaded Surface Mount Packages • JESD51-9, Test Boards for Area Array Surface Mount Package Thermal Measurements N/A = not applicable Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 25 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Schmitt-Trigger Inputs – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (1) (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3, RSTDVCC) 5.7 over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VIT+ Positive-going input threshold voltage VIT– Negative-going input threshold voltage Vhys Input voltage hysteresis (VIT+ – VIT–) RPull Pullup or pulldown resistor (2) For pullup: VIN = VSS, For pulldown: VIN = VCC CI Input capacitance VIN = VSS or VCC (1) (2) VCC MIN 1.8 V 0.80 TYP 1.40 3V 1.50 2.10 1.8 V 0.45 1.00 3V 0.75 1.65 1.8 V 0.3 0.8 3V 0.4 1.0 20 35 MAX 50 5 UNIT V V V kΩ pF Same parametrics apply to clock input pin when crystal bypass mode is used on XT1 (XIN) or XT2 (XT2IN). RSTDVCC has a fixed pullup resistor that cannot be disabled. 5.8 Schmitt-Trigger Inputs – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5, RST/NMI, BSLEN) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VIT+ Positive-going input threshold voltage VCC = 3.0 V VIT– Negative-going input threshold voltage VCC = 3.0 V Vhys Input voltage hysteresis (VIT+ – VIT–) VCC = 3.0 V RPull Pullup or pulldown resistor (1) For pullup: VIN = VSS, For pulldown: VIN = VIO CI Input capacitance VIN = VSS or VIO (1) 5.9 VIO MIN 1.62 V 0.8 TYP 1.25 1.98 V 1.1 1.40 1.62 V 0.3 0.7 1.98 V 0.5 1.0 1.62 V to 1.98 V 0.3 0.8 V 50 kΩ 20 MAX 35 5 UNIT V V pF Also applies to RST pin when pullup or pulldown resistor is enabled. Inputs – Interrupts DVCC Domain Port P1 (P1.0 to P1.3) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER t(int) (1) External interrupt timing TEST CONDITIONS (1) VCC External trigger pulse duration to set interrupt flag 1.8 V, 3 V MIN MAX 20 UNIT ns An external signal sets the interrupt flag every time the minimum interrupt pulse duration t(int) is met. It may be set by trigger signals shorter than t(int). 5.10 Inputs – Interrupts DVIO Domain Ports P1 and P2 (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER t(int) (1) (2) 26 External interrupt timing (2) VIO (1) TEST CONDITIONS External trigger pulse duration to set interrupt flag, VCC = 1.8 V or 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V MIN MAX 20 UNIT ns In all test conditions, VIO ≤ VCC. An external signal sets the interrupt flag every time the minimum interrupt pulse duration t(int) is met. It may be set by trigger signals shorter than t(int). Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.11 Leakage Current – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER Ilkg(Px.y) (1) (2) High-impedance leakage current TEST CONDITIONS (1) (2) VCC MIN MAX 1.8 V, 3 V –50 50 UNIT nA The leakage current is measured with VSS or VCC applied to the corresponding pins, unless otherwise noted. The leakage of the digital port pins is measured individually. The port pin is selected for input and the pullup or pulldown resistor is disabled. 5.12 Leakage Current – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER Ilkg(Px.y) (1) (2) (3) High-impedance leakage current TEST CONDITIONS (2) (3) VIO (1) 1.62 V to 1.98 V MIN MAX –50 50 UNIT nA In all test conditions, VIO ≤ VCC. The leakage current is measured with VSS or VIO applied to the corresponding pins, unless otherwise noted. The leakage of the digital port pins is measured individually. The port pin is selected for input and the pullup or pulldown resistor is disabled. 5.13 Outputs – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (Full Drive Strength) (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS I(OHmax) = –3 mA (1) VOH High-level output voltage I(OHmax) = –10 mA (2) VCC 1.8 V I(OHmax) = –5 mA (1) 3V I(OHmax) = –15 mA (2) I(OLmax) = 3 mA VOL Low-level output voltage (2) MAX VCC VCC – 0.60 VCC VCC – 0.25 VCC VCC – 0.60 VCC VSS VSS + 0.25 VSS VSS + 0.60 VSS VSS + 0.25 VSS VSS + 0.60 (1) 1.8 V I(OLmax) = 10 mA (2) I(OLmax) = 5 mA (1) 3V I(OLmax) = 15 mA (2) (1) MIN VCC – 0.25 UNIT V V The maximum total current, I(OHmax) and I(OLmax), for all outputs combined should not exceed ±48 mA to hold the maximum voltage drop specified. The maximum total current, I(OHmax) and I(OLmax), for all outputs combined should not exceed ±100 mA to hold the maximum voltage drop specified. 5.14 Outputs – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (Reduced Drive Strength) (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS I(OHmax) = –1 mA VOH High-level output voltage I(OHmax) = –3 mA (3) I(OHmax) = –2 mA (2) I(OHmax) = –6 mA (3) I(OLmax) = 1 mA VOL Low-level output voltage (3) 1.8 V 3.0 V (2) I(OLmax) = 3 mA (3) I(OLmax) = 2 mA (2) I(OLmax) = 6 mA (3) (1) (2) VCC (2) 1.8 V 3.0 V MIN MAX VCC – 0.25 VCC VCC – 0.60 VCC VCC – 0.25 VCC VCC – 0.60 VCC VSS VSS + 0.25 VSS VSS + 0.60 VSS VSS + 0.25 VSS VSS + 0.60 UNIT V V Selecting reduced drive strength may reduce EMI. The maximum total current, I(OHmax) and I(OLmax), for all outputs combined, should not exceed ±48 mA to hold the maximum voltage drop specified. The maximum total current, I(OHmax) and I(OLmax), for all outputs combined, should not exceed ±100 mA to hold the maximum voltage drop specified. Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 27 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5.15 Outputs – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain (Full Drive Strength) (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER VOH High-level output voltage VOL Low-level output voltage (1) (2) TEST CONDITIONS I(OHmax) = –3 mA VIO (1) (2) I(OHmax) = –6 mA (2) I(OLmax) = 3 mA (2) I(OLmax) = 6 mA (2) 1.62 V to 1.98 V MIN MAX VIO – 0.25 VIO VIO – 0.50 VIO VSS VSS + 0.25 1.62 V to 1.98 V VSS VSS + 0.50 UNIT V V In all test conditions, VIO ≤ VCC. The maximum total current, I(OHmax) and I(OLmax), for all outputs combined, should not exceed ±48 mA to hold the maximum voltage drop specified. 5.16 Outputs – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain (Reduced Drive Strength) (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (1) PARAMETER VOH High-level output voltage VOL Low-level output voltage (1) (2) (3) 28 TEST CONDITIONS I(OHmax) = –1 mA VIO (2) (3) I(OHmax) = –2 mA (3) I(OLmax) = 1 mA (3) I(OLmax) = 2 mA (3) 1.62 V to 1.98 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V MIN MAX VIO – 0.25 VIO VIO – 0.50 VIO VSS VSS + 0.25 VSS VSS + 0.50 UNIT V V Selecting reduced drive strength may reduce EMI. In all test conditions, VIO ≤ VCC. The maximum total current, I(OHmax) and I(OLmax), for all outputs combined, should not exceed ±48 mA to hold the maximum voltage drop specified. Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.17 Output Frequency – General-Purpose I/O DVCC Domain (P1.0 to P1.3, P5.0 to P5.5, P6.0 to P6.7, PJ.0 to PJ.3) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER Port output frequency (with load) fPx.y fPort_CLK (1) (2) Clock output frequency TEST CONDITIONS (1) (2) ACLK, SMCLK, or MCLK, CL = 20 pF (2) MIN MAX VCC = 1.8 V, PMMCOREVx = 0 16 VCC = 3 V, PMMCOREVx = 3 25 VCC = 1.8 V, PMMCOREVx = 0 16 VCC = 3 V, PMMCOREVx = 3 25 UNIT MHz MHz A resistive divider with 2 × R1 between VCC and VSS is used as load. The output is connected to the center tap of the divider. For full drive strength, R1 = 550 Ω. For reduced drive strength, R1 = 1.6 kΩ. CL = 20 pF is connected to the output to VSS. The output voltage reaches at least 10% and 90% VCC at the specified toggle frequency. 5.18 Output Frequency – General-Purpose I/O DVIO Domain (P1.4 to P1.7, P2.0 to P2.7, P3.0 to P3.4, P4.0 to P4.7, P7.0 to P7.5) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER Port output frequency (with load) fPx.y fPort_CLK (1) (2) (3) Clock output frequency TEST CONDITIONS (1) (2) ACLK, SMCLK, or MCLK, CL = 20 pF (2) MIN MAX VIO = 1.62 V to 1.98 V (3), PMMCOREVx = 0 16 VIO = 1.62 V to 1.98 V (3), PMMCOREVx = 3 25 VIO = 1.62 V to 1.98 V (3), PMMCOREVx = 0 16 VIO = 1.62 V to 1.98 V (3), PMMCOREVx = 3 25 UNIT MHz MHz A resistive divider with 2 × R1 between VIO and VSS is used as load. The output is connected to the center tap of the divider. For full drive strength, R1 = 550 Ω. For reduced drive strength, R1 = 1.6 kΩ. CL = 20 pF is connected to the output to VSS. The output voltage reaches at least 10% and 90% VIO at the specified toggle frequency. In all test conditions, VIO ≤ VCC. Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 29 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5.19 Typical Characteristics – Outputs, Reduced Drive Strength (PxDS.y = 0) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) 8.0 VCC = 3.0 V Px.y IOL – Typical Low-Level Output Current – mA IOL – Typical Low-Level Output Current – mA 25.0 TA = 25°C 20.0 TA = 85°C 15.0 10.0 5.0 0.0 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 VOL – Low-Level Output Voltage – V Figure 5-4. Typical Low-Level Output Current vs Low-Level Output Voltage IOH – Typical High-Level Output Current – mA IOH – Typical High-Level Output Current – mA -5.0 -10.0 TA = 85°C TA = 25°C 3.0 2.0 1.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 VCC = 1.8 V Px.y -1.0 -2.0 -3.0 -4.0 TA = 85°C -5.0 -6.0 TA = 25°C -7.0 -8.0 -25.0 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 VOH – High-Level Output Voltage – V Figure 5-6. Typical High-Level Output Current vs High-Level Output Voltage 30 4.0 0.0 VCC = 3.0 V Px.y -20.0 5.0 VOL – Low-Level Output Voltage – V Figure 5-5. Typical Low-Level Output Current vs Low-Level Output Voltage 0.0 -15.0 TA = 85°C 6.0 0.0 0.0 3.5 TA = 25°C VCC = 1.8 V Px.y 7.0 Specifications 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 VOH – High-Level Output Voltage – V Figure 5-7. Typical High-Level Output Current vs High-Level Output Voltage Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.20 Typical Characteristics – Outputs, Full Drive Strength (PxDS.y = 1) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) TA = 25°C VCC = 3.0 V Px.y 55.0 50.0 IOL – Typical Low-Level Output Current – mA IOL – Typical Low-Level Output Current – mA 60.0 TA = 85°C 45.0 40.0 35.0 30.0 25.0 20.0 15.0 10.0 5.0 0.0 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 IOH – Typical High-Level Output Current – mA IOH – Typical High-Level Output Current – mA -10.0 -15.0 -20.0 -25.0 -30.0 -35.0 -40.0 -45.0 TA = 85°C -55.0 TA = 25°C -60.0 0.0 TA = 85°C 16 12 8 4 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 0 VCC = 3.0 V Px.y -50.0 TA = 25°C 20 VOL – Low-Level Output Voltage – V Figure 5-9. Typical Low-Level Output Current vs Low-Level Output Voltage 0.0 -5.0 VCC = 1.8 V Px.y 0 0.0 3.5 VOL – Low-Level Output Voltage – V Figure 5-8. Typical Low-Level Output Current vs Low-Level Output Voltage 24 0.5 VCC = 1.8 V Px.y -4 -8 -12 TA = 85°C -16 TA = 25°C -20 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 VOH – High-Level Output Voltage – V Figure 5-10. Typical High-Level Output Current vs High-Level Output Voltage 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 VOH – High-Level Output Voltage – V Figure 5-11. Typical High-Level Output Current vs High-Level Output Voltage Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 2.0 31 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5.21 Crystal Oscillator, XT1, Low-Frequency Mode over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN fOSC = 32768 Hz, XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 1, TA = 25°C ΔIDVCC.LF Differential XT1 oscillator crystal current consumption from lowest drive setting, LF mode fOSC = 32768 Hz, XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 2, TA = 25°C 0.170 32768 XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 0 fXT1,LF,SW XT1 oscillator logic-level squarewave input frequency, LF mode XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 1 (2) (3) XT1BYPASSLV = 0 or 1 OALF 3.0 V 0.290 XT1 oscillator crystal frequency, LF mode 10 CL,eff fFault,LF tSTART,LF (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) 32 32.768 XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 0, fXT1,LF = 32768 Hz, CL,eff = 6 pF 210 XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 1, fXT1,LF = 32768 Hz, CL,eff = 12 pF 300 µA Hz 50 5.5 XTS = 0, XCAPx = 2 8.5 XTS = 0, XCAPx = 3 12.0 pF Duty cycle, LF mode XTS = 0, Measured at ACLK, fXT1,LF = 32768 Hz 30% 70% Oscillator fault frequency, LF mode (7) XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 1 (8), XT1BYPASSLV = 0 or 1 10 10000 Start-up time, LF mode fOSC = 32768 Hz, XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 3, TA = 25°C, CL,eff = 12 pF kHz 1 XTS = 0, XCAPx = 1 fOSC = 32768 Hz, XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 0, TA = 25°C, CL,eff = 6 pF UNIT kΩ XTS = 0, XCAPx = 0 (6) Integrated effective load capacitance, LF mode (5) MAX 0.075 fOSC = 32768 Hz, XTS = 0, XT1BYPASS = 0, XT1DRIVEx = 3, TA = 25°C fXT1,LF0 Oscillation allowance for LF crystals (4) TYP Hz 1000 3.0 V ms 500 To improve EMI on the XT1 oscillator, the following guidelines should be observed. • Keep the trace between the device and the crystal as short as possible. • Design a good ground plane around the oscillator pins. • Prevent crosstalk from other clock or data lines into oscillator pins XIN and XOUT. • Avoid running PCB traces underneath or adjacent to the XIN and XOUT pins. • Use assembly materials and processes that avoid any parasitic load on the oscillator XIN and XOUT pins. • If conformal coating is used, make sure that it does not induce capacitive or resistive leakage between the oscillator pins. When XT1BYPASS is set, XT1 circuits are automatically powered down. Input signal is a digital square wave with parametrics defined in the Schmitt-Trigger Inputs section of this data sheet. When in crystal bypass mode, XIN can be configured so that it can support an input digital waveform with swing levels from DVSS to DVCC (XT1BYPASSLV = 0) or DVSS to DVIO (XT1BYPASSLV = 1). In this case, the pin must be configured properly for the intended input swing. Maximum frequency of operation of the entire device cannot be exceeded. Oscillation allowance is based on a safety factor of 5 for recommended crystals. The oscillation allowance is a function of the XT1DRIVEx settings and the effective load. In general, comparable oscillator allowance can be achieved based on the following guidelines, but each application should be evaluated based on the actual crystal selected: • For XT1DRIVEx = 0, CL,eff ≤ 6 pF • For XT1DRIVEx = 1, 6 pF ≤ CL,eff ≤ 9 pF • For XT1DRIVEx = 2, 6 pF ≤ CL,eff ≤ 10 pF • For XT1DRIVEx = 3, CL,eff ≥ 6 pF Includes parasitic bond and package capacitance (approximately 2 pF per pin). Because the PCB adds additional capacitance, TI recommends verifying the correct load by measuring the ACLK frequency. For a correct setup, the effective load capacitance should always match the specification of the used crystal. Requires external capacitors at both terminals. Values are specified by crystal manufacturers. Frequencies below the MIN specification set the fault flag. Frequencies above the MAX specification do not set the fault flag. Frequencies between the MIN and MAX specifications might set the flag. Measured with logic-level input frequency but also applies to operation with crystals. Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.22 Crystal Oscillator, XT2 over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (1) (2) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN fOSC = 4 MHz, XT2OFF = 0, XT2BYPASS = 0, XT2DRIVEx = 0, TA = 25°C IDVCC.XT2 XT2 oscillator crystal current consumption fOSC = 12 MHz, XT2OFF = 0, XT2BYPASS = 0, XT2DRIVEx = 1, TA = 25°C fOSC = 20 MHz, XT2OFF = 0, XT2BYPASS = 0, XT2DRIVEx = 2, TA = 25°C TYP MAX UNIT 200 260 3.0 V µA 325 fOSC = 32 MHz, XT2OFF = 0, XT2BYPASS = 0, XT2DRIVEx = 3, TA = 25°C 450 fXT2,HF0 XT2 oscillator crystal frequency, mode 0 XT2DRIVEx = 0, XT2BYPASS = 0 (3) 4 8 MHz fXT2,HF1 XT2 oscillator crystal frequency, mode 1 XT2DRIVEx = 1, XT2BYPASS = 0 (3) 8 16 MHz fXT2,HF2 XT2 oscillator crystal frequency, mode 2 XT2DRIVEx = 2, XT2BYPASS = 0 (3) 16 24 MHz fXT2,HF3 XT2 oscillator crystal frequency, mode 3 XT2DRIVEx = 3, XT2BYPASS = 0 (3) 24 32 MHz fXT2,HF,SW XT2 oscillator logic-level squarewave input frequency, bypass mode XT2BYPASS = 1 (4) (3) XT2BYPASSLV = 0 or 1 0.7 32 MHz OAHF tSTART,HF CL,eff Oscillation allowance for HF crystals (5) Start-up time Integrated effective load capacitance, HF mode (6) (3) (4) (5) (6) 450 XT2DRIVEx = 1, XT2BYPASS = 0, fXT2,HF1 = 12 MHz, CL,eff = 15 pF 320 XT2DRIVEx = 2, XT2BYPASS = 0, fXT2,HF2 = 20 MHz, CL,eff = 15 pF 200 XT2DRIVEx = 3, XT2BYPASS = 0, fXT2,HF3 = 32 MHz, CL,eff = 15 pF 200 fOSC = 6 MHz, XT2BYPASS = 0, XT2DRIVEx = 0, TA = 25°C, CL,eff = 15 pF 0.5 fOSC = 20 MHz, XT2BYPASS = 0, XT2DRIVEx = 2, TA = 25°C, CL,eff = 15 pF Ω 3.0 V ms 0.3 1 (1) Duty cycle (1) (2) XT2DRIVEx = 0, XT2BYPASS = 0, fXT2,HF0 = 6 MHz, CL,eff = 15 pF Measured at ACLK, fXT2,HF2 = 20 MHz 40% 50% pF 60% Requires external capacitors at both terminals. Values are specified by crystal manufacturers. To improve EMI on the XT2 oscillator the following guidelines should be observed. • Keep the traces between the device and the crystal as short as possible. • Design a good ground plane around the oscillator pins. • Prevent crosstalk from other clock or data lines into oscillator pins XT2IN and XT2OUT. • Avoid running PCB traces underneath or adjacent to the XT2IN and XT2OUT pins. • Use assembly materials and processes that avoid any parasitic load on the oscillator XT2IN and XT2OUT pins. • If conformal coating is used, make sure that it does not induce capacitive or resistive leakage between the oscillator pins. This represents the maximum frequency that can be input to the device externally. Maximum frequency achievable on the device operation is based on the frequencies present on ACLK, MCLK, and SMCLK cannot be exceed for a given range of operation. When XT2BYPASS is set, the XT2 circuit is automatically powered down. Input signal is a digital square wave with parametrics defined in the Schmitt-trigger Inputs section of this data sheet. When in crystal bypass mode, XT2IN can be configured so that it can support an input digital waveform with swing levels from DVSS to DVCC (XT2BYPASSLV = 0) or DVSS to DVIO (XT2BYPASSLV = 1). In this case, it is required that the pin be configured properly for the intended input swing. Oscillation allowance is based on a safety factor of 5 for recommended crystals. Includes parasitic bond and package capacitance (approximately 2 pF per pin). Because the PCB adds additional capacitance, TI recommends verifying the correct load by measuring the ACLK frequency. For a correct setup, the effective load capacitance should always match the specification of the used crystal. Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 33 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Crystal Oscillator, XT2 (continued) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted)(1)(2) PARAMETER fFault,HF (7) (8) Oscillator fault frequency TEST CONDITIONS (7) VCC XT2BYPASS = 1 (8), XT2BYPASSLV = 0 or 1 MIN TYP 30 MAX UNIT 300 kHz Frequencies below the MIN specification set the fault flag. Frequencies above the MAX specification do not set the fault flag. Frequencies between the MIN and MAX specifications might set the flag. Measured with logic-level input frequency but also applies to operation with crystals. In general, an effective load capacitance of up to 18 pF can be supported. 5.23 Internal Very-Low-Power Low-Frequency Oscillator (VLO) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX 6 9.4 14 UNIT fVLO VLO frequency Measured at ACLK 1.8 V to 3.6 V dfVLO/dT VLO frequency temperature drift Measured at ACLK (1) 1.8 V to 3.6 V 0.5 %/°C Measured at ACLK (2) 1.8 V to 3.6 V 4 %/V Measured at ACLK 1.8 V to 3.6 V dfVLO/dVCC VLO frequency supply voltage drift Duty cycle (1) (2) 40% 50% kHz 60% Calculated using the box method: (MAX(–40°C to 85°C) – MIN(–40°C to 85°C)) / MIN(–40°C to 85°C) / (85°C – (–40°C)) Calculated using the box method: (MAX(1.8 V to 3.6 V) – MIN(1.8 V to 3.6 V)) / MIN(1.8 V to 3.6 V) / (3.6 V – 1.8 V) 5.24 Internal Reference, Low-Frequency Oscillator (REFO) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER IREFO fREFO TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP REFO oscillator current consumption TA = 25°C 1.8 V to 3.6 V 3 REFO frequency Measured at ACLK 1.8 V to 3.6 V 32768 Full temperature range 1.8 V to 3.6 V –3.5% 3.5% 3V –1.5% 1.5% REFO absolute tolerance TA = 25°C (1) dfREFO/dT REFO frequency temperature drift Measured at ACLK 1.8 V to 3.6 V 0.01 dfREFO/dVCC REFO frequency supply voltage drift Measured at ACLK (2) 1.8 V to 3.6 V 1.0 Duty cycle Measured at ACLK 1.8 V to 3.6 V REFO start-up time 40%/60% duty cycle 1.8 V to 3.6 V tSTART (1) (2) 34 MAX 40% 50% UNIT µA Hz %/°C %/V 60% 25 µs Calculated using the box method: (MAX(–40°C to 85°C) – MIN(–40°C to 85°C)) / MIN(–40°C to 85°C) / (85°C – (–40°C)) Calculated using the box method: (MAX(1.8 V to 3.6 V) – MIN(1.8 V to 3.6 V)) / MIN(1.8 V to 3.6 V) / (3.6 V – 1.8 V) Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.25 DCO Frequency over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS (1) MIN TYP MAX UNIT fDCO(0,0) DCO frequency (0, 0) DCORSELx = 0, DCOx = 0, MODx = 0 0.07 0.20 MHz fDCO(0,31) DCO frequency (0, 31) (1) DCORSELx = 0, DCOx = 31, MODx = 0 0.70 1.70 MHz fDCO(1,0) DCO frequency (1, 0) (1) DCORSELx = 1, DCOx = 0, MODx = 0 0.15 0.36 MHz fDCO(1,31) DCO frequency (1, 31) (1) DCORSELx = 1, DCOx = 31, MODx = 0 1.47 3.45 MHz (1) fDCO(2,0) DCO frequency (2, 0) DCORSELx = 2, DCOx = 0, MODx = 0 0.32 0.75 MHz fDCO(2,31) DCO frequency (2, 31) (1) DCORSELx = 2, DCOx = 31, MODx = 0 3.17 7.38 MHz fDCO(3,0) DCO frequency (3, 0) (1) DCORSELx = 3, DCOx = 0, MODx = 0 0.64 1.51 MHz (1) fDCO(3,31) DCO frequency (3, 31) DCORSELx = 3, DCOx = 31, MODx = 0 6.07 14.0 MHz fDCO(4,0) DCO frequency (4, 0) (1) DCORSELx = 4, DCOx = 0, MODx = 0 1.3 3.2 MHz fDCO(4,31) DCO frequency (4, 31) (1) DCORSELx = 4, DCOx = 31, MODx = 0 12.3 28.2 MHz (1) fDCO(5,0) DCO frequency (5, 0) DCORSELx = 5, DCOx = 0, MODx = 0 2.5 6.0 MHz fDCO(5,31) DCO frequency (5, 31) (1) DCORSELx = 5, DCOx = 31, MODx = 0 23.7 54.1 MHz fDCO(6,0) DCO frequency (6, 0) (1) DCORSELx = 6, DCOx = 0, MODx = 0 4.6 10.7 MHz fDCO(6,31) DCO frequency (6, 31) (1) DCORSELx = 6, DCOx = 31, MODx = 0 39.0 88.0 MHz (1) fDCO(7,0) DCO frequency (7, 0) DCORSELx = 7, DCOx = 0, MODx = 0 8.5 19.6 MHz fDCO(7,31) DCO frequency (7, 31) (1) DCORSELx = 7, DCOx = 31, MODx = 0 60 135 MHz SDCORSEL Frequency step between range DCORSEL and DCORSEL + 1 SRSEL = fDCO(DCORSEL+1,DCO)/fDCO(DCORSEL,DCO) 1.2 2.3 ratio SDCO Frequency step between tap DCO and DCO + 1 SDCO = fDCO(DCORSEL,DCO+1)/fDCO(DCORSEL,DCO) 1.02 1.12 ratio Duty cycle Measured at SMCLK 40% DCO frequency temperature drift (2) dfDCO/dT dfDCO/dVCC (1) (2) (3) DCO frequency voltage drift (3) 50% 60% fDCO = 1 MHz 0.1 %/°C fDCO = 1 MHz 1.9 %/V When selecting the proper DCO frequency range (DCORSELx), the target DCO frequency, fDCO, should be set to reside within the range of fDCO(n, 0),MAX ≤ fDCO ≤ fDCO(n, 31),MIN, where fDCO(n, 0),MAX represents the maximum frequency specified for the DCO frequency, range n, tap 0 (DCOx = 0) and fDCO(n,31),MIN represents the minimum frequency specified for the DCO frequency, range n, tap 31 (DCOx = 31). This ensures that the target DCO frequency resides within the range selected. It should also be noted that if the actual fDCO frequency for the selected range causes the FLL or the application to select tap 0 or 31, the DCO fault flag is set to report that the selected range is at its minimum or maximum tap setting. Calculated using the box method: (MAX(–40°C to 85°C) – MIN(–40°C to 85°C)) / MIN(–40°C to 85°C) / (85°C – (–40°C)) Calculated using the box method: (MAX(1.8 V to 3.6 V) – MIN(1.8 V to 3.6 V)) / MIN(1.8 V to 3.6 V) / (3.6 V – 1.8 V) Typical DCO Frequency, VCC = 3.0 V, TA = 25°C 100 fDCO – MHz 10 DCOx = 31 1 0.1 DCOx = 0 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 DCORSEL Figure 5-12. Typical DCO frequency Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 35 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5.26 PMM, Brown-Out Reset (BOR) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VDVCC_BOR_IT– BORH on voltage, DVCC falling level | dDVCC/dt | < 3 V/s VDVCC_BOR_IT+ BORH off voltage, DVCC rising level | dDVCC/dt | < 3 V/s VDVCC_BOR_hys BORH hysteresis tRESET Pulse duration required at RST/NMI pin to accept a reset MIN TYP 0.80 1.30 60 MAX UNIT 1.45 V 1.50 V 250 mV 2 µs 5.27 PMM, Core Voltage over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT VCORE3(AM) Core voltage, active mode, PMMCOREV = 3 2.4 V ≤ DVCC ≤ 3.6 V 1.90 V VCORE2(AM) Core voltage, active mode, PMMCOREV = 2 2.2 V ≤ DVCC ≤ 3.6 V 1.80 V VCORE1(AM) Core voltage, active mode, PMMCOREV = 1 2.0 V ≤ DVCC ≤ 3.6 V 1.60 V VCORE0(AM) Core voltage, active mode, PMMCOREV = 0 1.8 V ≤ DVCC ≤ 3.6 V 1.40 V VCORE3(LPM) Core voltage, low-current mode, PMMCOREV = 3 2.4 V ≤ DVCC ≤ 3.6 V 1.94 V VCORE2(LPM) Core voltage, low-current mode, PMMCOREV = 2 2.2 V ≤ DVCC ≤ 3.6 V 1.84 V VCORE1(LPM) Core voltage, low-current mode, PMMCOREV = 1 2.0 V ≤ DVCC ≤ 3.6 V 1.64 V VCORE0(LPM) Core voltage, low-current mode, PMMCOREV = 0 1.8 V ≤ DVCC ≤ 3.6 V 1.44 V 36 Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.28 PMM, SVS High Side over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN SVSHE = 0, DVCC = 3.6 V I(SVSH) SVS current consumption V(SVSH_IT+) tpd(SVSH) t(SVSH) dVDVCC/dt (1) SVSH on voltage level (1) SVSH off voltage level (1) SVSH propagation delay SVSH on or off delay time MAX 0 SVSHE = 1, DVCC = 3.6 V, SVSHFP = 0 1.5 µA SVSHE = 1, SVSHRVL = 0 1.57 1.68 1.78 SVSHE = 1, SVSHRVL = 1 1.79 1.88 1.98 SVSHE = 1, SVSHRVL = 2 1.98 2.08 2.21 SVSHE = 1, SVSHRVL = 3 2.10 2.18 2.31 SVSHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 0 1.62 1.74 1.85 SVSHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 1 1.88 1.94 2.07 SVSHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 2 2.07 2.14 2.28 SVSHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 3 2.20 2.30 2.42 SVSHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 4 2.32 2.40 2.55 SVSHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 5 2.52 2.70 2.88 SVSHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 6 2.90 3.10 3.23 SVSHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 7 2.90 3.10 3.23 SVSHE = 1, dVDVCC/dt = 10 mV/µs, SVSHFP = 1 2.5 SVSHE = 1, dVDVCC/dt = 1 mV/µs, SVSHFP = 0 20 V V µs SVSHE = 0 → 1, dVDVCC/dt = 10 mV/µs, SVSHFP = 1 12.5 SVSHE = 0 → 1, dVDVCC/dt = 1 mV/µs, SVSHFP = 0 100 DVCC rise time UNIT nA 200 SVSHE = 1, DVCC = 3.6 V, SVSHFP = 1 V(SVSH_IT–) TYP µs 0 1000 V/s The SVSH settings available depend on the VCORE (PMMCOREVx) setting. See the Power Management Module and Supply Voltage Supervisor chapter in the MSP430x5xx and MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide (SLAU208) on recommended settings and use. Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 37 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5.29 PMM, SVM High Side over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP SVMHE = 0, DVCC = 3.6 V I(SVMH) SVMH current consumption 0 SVMHE= 1, DVCC = 3.6 V, SVMHFP = 0 V(SVMH) SVMH on or off voltage level 1.5 tpd(SVMH) t(SVMH) (1) SVMH propagation delay SVMH on or off delay time µA SVMHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 0 1.62 1.74 1.85 SVMHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 1 1.88 1.94 2.07 SVMHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 2 2.07 2.14 2.28 SVMHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 3 2.20 2.30 2.42 SVMHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 4 2.32 2.40 2.55 SVMHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 5 2.52 2.70 2.88 SVMHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 6 2.90 3.10 3.23 SVMHE = 1, SVSMHRRL = 7 2.90 3.10 3.23 SVMHE = 1, SVMHOVPE = 1 UNIT nA 200 SVMHE = 1, DVCC = 3.6 V, SVMHFP = 1 (1) MAX V 3.75 SVMHE = 1, dVDVCC/dt = 10 mV/µs, SVMHFP = 1 2.5 SVMHE = 1, dVDVCC/dt = 1 mV/µs, SVMHFP = 0 20 µs SVMHE = 0 → 1, dVDVCC/dt = 10 mV/µs, SVMHFP = 1 12.5 SVMHE = 0 → 1, dVDVCC/dt = 1 mV/µs, SVMHFP = 0 100 µs The SVMH settings available depend on the VCORE (PMMCOREVx) setting. See the Power Management Module and Supply Voltage Supervisor chapter in the MSP430x5xx and MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide (SLAU208) on recommended settings and use. 5.30 PMM, SVS Low Side over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN SVSLE = 0, PMMCOREV = 2 I(SVSL) SVSL current consumption tpd(SVSL) t(SVSL) 38 SVSL propagation delay SVSL on or off delay time Specifications TYP MAX 0 SVSLE = 1, PMMCOREV = 2, SVSLFP = 0 200 SVSLE = 1, PMMCOREV = 2, SVSLFP = 1 1.5 SVSLE = 1, dVCORE/dt = 10 mV/µs, SVSLFP = 1 2.5 SVSLE = 1, dVCORE/dt = 1 mV/µs, SVSLFP = 0 20 UNIT nA µA µs SVSLE = 0 → 1, dVCORE/dt = 10 mV/µs, SVSLFP = 1 12.5 SVSLE = 0 → 1, dVCORE/dt = 1 mV/µs, SVSLFP = 0 100 µs Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.31 PMM, SVM Low Side over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN SVMLE = 0, PMMCOREV = 2 I(SVML) tpd(SVML) t(SVML) SVML current consumption SVML propagation delay SVML on or off delay time TYP MAX 0 SVMLE= 1, PMMCOREV = 2, SVMLFP = 0 200 SVMLE= 1, PMMCOREV = 2, SVMLFP = 1 1.5 SVMLE = 1, dVCORE/dt = 10 mV/µs, SVMLFP = 1 2.5 SVMLE = 1, dVCORE/dt = 1 mV/µs, SVMLFP = 0 20 UNIT nA µA µs SVMLE = 0 → 1, dVCORE/dt = 10 mV/µs, SVMLFP = 1 12.5 SVMLE = 0 → 1, dVCORE/dt = 1 mV/µs, SVMLFP = 0 100 µs 5.32 Wake-up Times From Low-Power Modes and Reset over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS TYP MAX fMCLK ≥ 4.0 MHz MIN 3.5 7.5 UNIT 1.0 MHz < fMCLK < 4.0 MHz 4.5 9 150 175 µs tWAKE-UP-FAST Wake-up time from LPM2, LPM3, or LPM4 to active mode (1) PMMCOREV = SVSMLRRL = n (where n = 0, 1, 2, or 3), SVSLFP = 1 tWAKE-UP-SLOW Wake-up time from LPM2, LPM3 or LPM4 to active mode (2) PMMCOREV = SVSMLRRL = n (where n = 0, 1, 2, or 3), SVSLFP = 0 tWAKE-UP-LPM5 Wake-up time from LPM4.5 to active mode (3) 2 3 ms tWAKE-UP-RESET Wake-up time from RST or BOR event to active mode (3) 2 3 ms (1) (2) (3) µs This value represents the time from the wake-up event to the first active edge of MCLK. The wake-up time depends on the performance mode of the low side supervisor (SVSL) and low side monitor (SVML). Fastest wake-up times are possible with SVSLand SVML in full performance mode or disabled when operating in AM, LPM0, and LPM1. Various options are available for SVSLand SVML while operating in LPM2, LPM3, and LPM4. See the Power Management Module and Supply Voltage Supervisor chapter in the MSP430x5xx and MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide (SLAU208). This value represents the time from the wake-up event to the first active edge of MCLK. The wake-up time depends on the performance mode of the low side supervisor (SVSL) and low side monitor (SVML). In this case, the SVSLand SVML are in normal mode (low current) mode when operating in AM, LPM0, and LPM1. Various options are available for SVSLand SVML while operating in LPM2, LPM3, and LPM4. See the Power Management Module and Supply Voltage Supervisor chapter in the MSP430x5xx and MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide (SLAU208). This value represents the time from the wake-up event to the reset vector execution. Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 39 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5.33 Timer_A over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC VIO MIN TYP MAX UNIT 1.62 V to 1.8 V 25 Timer_A input clock frequency Internal: SMCLK, ACLK External: TACLK Duty cycle = 50% ± 10% 1.8 V fTA 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 25 Timer_A capture timing (1) All capture inputs, Minimum pulse duration required for capture 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.8 V 20 tTA,cap 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 20 (1) MHz ns The external signal sets the interrupt flag every time the minimum parameters are met. It may be set even with trigger signals shorter than tTA,cap. 5.34 Timer_B over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC VIO MIN TYP MAX UNIT 1.62 V to 1.8 V 25 Timer_B input clock frequency Internal: SMCLK, ACLK External: TBCLK Duty cycle = 50% ± 10% 1.8 V fTB 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 25 Timer_B capture timing (1) All capture inputs, Minimum pulse duration required for capture 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.8 V 20 tTB,cap 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 20 (1) 40 MHz ns The external signal sets the interrupt flag every time the minimum parameters are met. It may be set even with trigger signals shorter than tTB,cap. Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.35 USCI (UART Mode), Recommended Operating Conditions PARAMETER fUSCI USCI input clock frequency fBITCLK BITCLK clock frequency (equals baud rate in MBaud) CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP Internal: SMCLK, ACLK External: UCLK Duty cycle = 50% ± 10% MAX UNIT fSYSTEM MHz 1 MHz MAX UNIT 5.36 USCI (UART Mode) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER UART receive deglitch time (1) tτ (1) TEST CONDITIONS VCC VIO 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V MIN 50 TYP 600 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 50 600 ns Pulses on the UART receive input (UCxRX) shorter than the UART receive deglitch time are suppressed. To ensure that pulses are correctly recognized, their duration should exceed the maximum specification of the deglitch time. 5.37 USCI (SPI Master Mode), Recommended Operating Conditions PARAMETER fUSCI CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP Internal: SMCLK or ACLK, Duty cycle = 50% ± 10% USCI input clock frequency MAX UNIT fSYSTEM MHz MAX UNIT fSYSTEM MHz 5.38 USCI (SPI Master Mode) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (see Note (1), Figure 5-13 and Figure 5-14) PARAMETER fUSCI USCI input clock frequency TEST CONDITIONS PMMCOREV = 0 tSU,MI SOMI input data setup time PMMCOREV = 3 PMMCOREV = 0 tHD,MI SOMI input data hold time PMMCOREV = 3 tVALID,MO tHD,MO (1) (2) (3) SIMO output data valid time (2) SIMO output data hold time (3) VCC VIO MIN SMCLK or ACLK, Duty cycle = 50% ± 10% 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 55 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 55 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 35 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 35 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 0 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 0 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 0 0 TYP ns ns 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V UCLK edge to SIMO valid, CL = 20 pF, PMMCOREV = 0 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 20 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 20 UCLK edge to SIMO valid, CL = 20 pF, PMMCOREV = 3 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 16 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 16 CL = 20 pF, PMMCOREV = 0 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V –10 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V –10 CL = 20 pF, PMMCOREV = 3 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V –10 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V –10 ns ns fUCxCLK = 1/2tLO/HI with tLO/HI ≥ max(tVALID,MO(USCI) + tSU,SI(Slave), tSU,MI(USCI) + tVALID,SO(Slave)). For the slave parameters tSU,SI(Slave) and tVALID,SO(Slave) see the SPI parameters of the attached slave. Specifies the time to drive the next valid data to the SIMO output after the output changing UCLK clock edge. See the timing diagrams in Figure 5-13 and Figure 5-14. Specifies how long data on the SIMO output is valid after the output changing UCLK clock edge. Negative values indicate that the data on the SIMO output can become invalid before the output changing clock edge observed on UCLK. See the timing diagrams in Figure 513 and Figure 5-14. Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 41 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 1/fUCxCLK CKPL = 0 UCLK CKPL = 1 tLO/HI tLO/HI tSU,MI tHD,MI SOMI tHD,MO tVALID,MO SIMO Figure 5-13. SPI Master Mode, CKPH = 0 1/fUCxCLK CKPL = 0 UCLK CKPL = 1 tLO/HI tLO/HI tHD,MI tSU,MI SOMI tHD,MO tVALID,MO SIMO Figure 5-14. SPI Master Mode, CKPH = 1 42 Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.39 USCI (SPI Slave Mode) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (see Note (1), Figure 5-15 and Figure 5-16) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS PMMCOREV = 0 tSTE,LEAD STE lead time, STE low to clock PMMCOREV = 3 PMMCOREV = 0 tSTE,LAG STE lag time, Last clock to STE high PMMCOREV = 3 PMMCOREV = 0 tSTE,ACC STE access time, STE low to SOMI data out PMMCOREV = 3 PMMCOREV = 0 tSTE,DIS STE disable time, STE high to SOMI high impedance PMMCOREV = 3 PMMCOREV = 0 tSU,SI SIMO input data setup time PMMCOREV = 3 PMMCOREV = 0 tHD,SI SIMO input data hold time PMMCOREV = 3 tVALID,SO tHD,SO (1) (2) (3) SOMI output data valid time (2) SOMI output data hold time (3) VCC VIO 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V MIN 12 TYP MAX 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 12 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 10 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 10 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 6 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 6 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 6 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 6 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 65 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 65 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 45 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 45 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 35 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 35 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 25 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 5 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 5 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 5 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 5 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 5 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 5 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 5 5 UNIT ns ns ns ns 25 ns ns 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V UCLK edge to SOMI valid, CL = 20 pF, PMMCOREV = 0 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 75 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 75 UCLK edge to SOMI valid, CL = 20 pF, PMMCOREV = 3 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 50 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 50 CL = 20 pF, PMMCOREV = 0 1.8 V 1.62 V to 1.80 V 18 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 18 CL = 20 pF, PMMCOREV = 3 2.4 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 10 3.0 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 10 ns ns fUCxCLK = 1/2tLO/HI with tLO/HI ≥ max(tVALID,MO(Master) + tSU,SI(USCI), tSU,MI(Master) + tVALID,SO(USCI)). For the master parameters tSU,MI(Master) and tVALID,MO(Master) see the SPI parameters of the attached slave. Specifies the time to drive the next valid data to the SOMI output after the output changing UCLK clock edge. See the timing diagrams in Figure 5-13 and Figure 5-14. Specifies how long data on the SOMI output is valid after the output changing UCLK clock edge. See the timing diagrams in Figure 5-13 and Figure 5-14. Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 43 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com tSTE,LEAD tSTE,LAG STE 1/fUCxCLK CKPL = 0 UCLK CKPL = 1 tLO/HI tSU,SI tLO/HI tHD,SI SIMO tHD,SO tVALID,SO tSTE,ACC tSTE,DIS SOMI Figure 5-15. SPI Slave Mode, CKPH = 0 tSTE,LAG tSTE,LEAD STE 1/fUCxCLK CKPL = 0 UCLK CKPL = 1 tLO/HI tLO/HI tHD,SI tSU,SI SIMO tSTE,ACC tHD,MO tVALID,SO tSTE,DIS SOMI Figure 5-16. SPI Slave Mode, CKPH = 1 44 Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.40 USCI (I2C Mode) over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (see Figure 5-17) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS fUSCI USCI input clock frequency fSCL SCL clock frequency tHD,STA Hold time (repeated) START tSU,STA Setup time for a repeated START tHD,DAT tSU,DAT MIN TYP Internal: SMCLK or ACLK, External: UCLK Duty cycle = 50% ± 10% UNIT fSYSTEM MHz 400 kHz 1.62 V to 1.98 V 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V Data hold time 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 0 ns Data setup time 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 250 ns fSCL ≤ 100 kHz fSCL > 100 kHz fSCL ≤ 100 kHz fSCL > 100 kHz fSCL ≤ 100 kHz Setup time for STOP tSP Pulse duration of spikes suppressed by input filter fSCL > 100 kHz 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 0 MAX 2.2 V, 3 V tSU,STO (1) VIO (1) VCC 4.0 µs 0.6 4.7 µs 0.6 4.0 µs 0.6 50 600 ns In all test conditions, VIO ≤ VCC tSU,STA tHD,STA tHD,STA tBUF SDA tLOW tHIGH tSP SCL tSU,DAT tSU,STO tHD,DAT Figure 5-17. I2C Mode Timing Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 45 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5.41 10-Bit ADC, Power Supply and Input Range Conditions over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (1) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS AVCC Analog supply voltage AVCC and DVCC are connected together, AVSS and DVSS are connected together, V(AVSS) = V(DVSS) = 0 V V(Ax) Analog input voltage range (2) All ADC10_A pins: P1.0 to P1.5 and P3.6 and P3.7 terminals Operating supply current into AVCC terminal, REF module and reference buffer off fADC10CLK = 5.0 MHz, ADC10ON = 1, REFON = 0, SHT0 = 0, SHT1 = 0, ADC10DIV = 0, ADC10SREF = 00 Operating supply current into AVCC terminal, REF module on, reference buffer on VCC MIN TYP MAX 1.8 3.6 V 0 AVCC V 2.2 V 60 100 3V 75 110 fADC10CLK = 5.0 MHz, ADC10ON = 1, REFON = 1, SHT0 = 0, SHT1 = 0, ADC10DIV = 0, ADC10SREF = 01 3V 113 150 Operating supply current into AVCC terminal, REF module off, reference buffer on fADC10CLK = 5.0 MHz, ADC10ON = 1, REFON = 0, SHT0 = 0, SHT1 = 0, ADC10DIV = 0, ADC10SREF = 10, VEREF = 2.5 V 3V 105 140 Operating supply current into AVCC terminal, REF module off, reference buffer off fADC10CLK = 5.0 MHz, ADC10ON = 1, REFON = 0, SHT0 = 0, SHT1 = 0, ADC10DIV = 0, ADC10SREF = 11, VEREF = 2.5 V 3V 70 110 CI Input capacitance Only one terminal Ax can be selected at one time from the pad to the ADC10_A capacitor array including wiring and pad 2.2 V 3.5 RI Input MUX ON resistance IADC10_A (1) (2) UNIT µA pF AVCC > 2 V, 0 V ≤ VAx ≤ AVCC 36 1.8 V < AVCC < 2 V, 0 V ≤ VAx ≤ AVCC 96 kΩ The leakage current is defined in the leakage current table with P6.x/Ax parameter. The analog input voltage range must be within the selected reference voltage range VR+ to VR– for valid conversion results. The external reference voltage requires decoupling capacitors. See (). 5.42 10-Bit ADC, Timing Parameters over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX UNIT 2.2 V, 3 V 0.45 5 5.5 MHz 4.8 5.4 MHz fADC10CLK Input clock frequency For specified performance of ADC10_A linearity parameters fADC10OSC Internal ADC10_A oscillator (1) ADC10DIV = 0, fADC10CLK = fADC10OSC 2.2 V, 3 V 4.2 2.2 V, 3 V 2.4 Conversion time REFON = 0, Internal oscillator, 12 ADC10CLK cycles, 10-bit mode fADC10OSC = 4 MHz to 5 MHz tCONVERT µs External fADC10CLK from ACLK, MCLK or SMCLK, ADC10SSEL ≠ 0 tADC10ON Turn on settling time of the ADC See tSample Sampling time RS = 1000 Ω, RI = 96 k Ω, CI = 3.5 pF (4) (1) (2) (3) (4) 46 3.0 (2) (3) 100 ns 1.8 V 3 µs 3.0 V 1 µs The ADC10OSC is sourced directly from MODOSC inside the UCS. 12 × ADC10DIV × 1/fADC10CLK The condition is that the error in a conversion started after tADC10ON is less than ±0.5 LSB. The reference and input signal are already settled. Approximately eight Tau (τ) are needed to get an error of less than ±0.5 LSB Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.43 10-Bit ADC, Linearity Parameters over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS 1.4 V ≤ (VeREF+ – VeREF–) ≤ 1.6 V, CVeREF+ = 20 pF VCC MIN TYP MAX ±1.0 UNIT EI Integral linearity error ED Differential linearity error 1.4 V ≤ (VeREF+ – VeREF–), CVeREF+ = 20 pF 2.2 V, 3 V ±1.0 LSB EO Offset error 1.4 V ≤ (VeREF+ – VeREF–), CVeREF+ = 20 pF Internal impedance of source RS < 100 Ω 2.2 V, 3 V ±1.0 LSB EG Gain error 1.4 V ≤ (VeREF+ – VeREF–), CVeREF+ = 20 pF, ADC10SREFx = 11b 2.2 V, 3 V ±1.0 LSB ET Total unadjusted error 1.4 V ≤ (VeREF+ – VeREF–), CVeREF+ = 20 pF, ADC10SREFx = 11b 2.2 V, 3 V ±2.0 LSB MAX UNIT 1.6 V < (VeREF+ – VeREF–) ≤ VAVCC, CVeREF+ = 20 pF 2.2 V, 3 V ±1.0 ±1.0 LSB 5.44 REF, External Reference over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (1) PARAMETER VeREF+ Positive external reference voltage input VeREF– (VeREF+ – VeREF–) IVeREF+, IVeREF– CVREF+, CVREF(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP VeREF+ > VeREF– (2) 1.4 AVCC V Negative external reference voltage input VeREF+ > VeREF– (3) 0 1.2 V Differential external reference voltage input VeREF+ > VeREF– (4) 1.4 AVCC V Static input current Capacitance at VeREF+ or VeREF- terminal 1.4 V ≤ VeREF+ ≤ VAVCC , VeREF– = 0 V, fADC10CLK = 5 MHz, ADC10SHTx = 0x0001, Conversion rate 200 ksps 2.2 V, 3 V –26 26 µA 1.4 V ≤ VeREF+ ≤ VAVCC , VeREF– = 0 V, fADC10CLK = 5 MHZ, ADC10SHTX = 0x1000, Conversion rate 20 ksps 2.2 V, 3 V –1 1 µA (5) 10 µF The external reference is used during ADC conversion to charge and discharge the capacitance array. The input capacitance, CI, is also the dynamic load for an external reference during conversion. The dynamic impedance of the reference supply should follow the recommendations on analog-source impedance to allow the charge to settle for 10-bit accuracy. The accuracy limits the minimum positive external reference voltage. Lower reference voltage levels may be applied with reduced accuracy requirements. The accuracy limits the maximum negative external reference voltage. Higher reference voltage levels may be applied with reduced accuracy requirements. The accuracy limits minimum external differential reference voltage. Lower differential reference voltage levels may be applied with reduced accuracy requirements. Two decoupling capacitors, 10 µF and 100 nF, should be connected to VREF to decouple the dynamic current required for an external reference source if it is used for the ADC10_A. See also the MSP430x5xx and MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide (SLAU208). Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 47 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5.45 REF, Built-In Reference over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) (1) PARAMETER Positive built-in reference voltage VREF+ AVCC minimum voltage, Positive built-in reference active AVCC(min) Operating supply current into AVCC terminal (2) IREF+ TEST CONDITIONS VCC MIN TYP MAX REFVSEL = {2} for 2.5 V REFON = 1 3V 2.472 2.51 2.548 REFVSEL = {1} for 2.0 V REFON = 1 3V 1.96 1.99 2.02 REFVSEL = {0} for 1.5 V REFON = 1 2.2 V, 3 V 1.472 1.495 1.518 REFVSEL = {0} for 1.5 V 1.8 REFVSEL = {1} for 2.0 V 2.2 REFVSEL = {2} for 2.5 V 2.7 UNIT V V fADC10CLK = 5.0 MHz REFON = 1, REFBURST = 0, REFVSEL = {2} for 2.5 V 3V 18 24 fADC10CLK = 5.0 MHz REFON = 1, REFBURST = 0, REFVSEL = {1} for 2.0 V 3V 15.5 21 fADC10CLK = 5.0 MHz REFON = 1, REFBURST = 0, REFVSEL = {0} for 1.5 V 3V 13.5 21 30 50 µA TCREF+ Temperature coefficient of built-in reference (3) IVREF+ = 0 A REFVSEL = (0, 1, 2}, REFON = 1 ISENSOR Operating supply current into AVCC terminal (4) REFON = 0, INCH = 0Ah, ADC10ON = N A, TA = 30°C 2.2 V 20 22 3V 20 22 VSENSOR See ADC10ON = 1, INCH = 0Ah, TA = 30°C 2.2 V 770 3V 770 VMID AVCC divider at channel 11 ADC10ON = 1, INCH = 0Bh, VMID ≈ 0.5 × VAVCC 2.2 V 1.06 1.1 1.14 3V 1.46 1.5 1.54 tSENSOR(sample) Sample time required if channel 10 is selected (6) ADC10ON = 1, INCH = 0Ah, Error of conversion result ≤ 1 LSB 30 µs tVMID(sample) Sample time required if channel 11 is selected (7) ADC10ON = 1, INCH = 0Bh, Error of conversion result ≤ 1 LSB 1 µs PSRR_DC Power supply rejection ratio (dc) AVCC = AVCC (min) - AVCC(max), TA = 25°C, REFVSEL = {0, 1, 2}, REFON = 1 120 µV/V PSRR_AC Power supply rejection ratio (ac) AVCC = AVCC (min) - AVCC(max), TA = 25°C, f = 1 kHz, ΔVpp = 100 mV REFVSEL = {0, 1, 2}, REFON = 1 6.4 mV/V tSETTLE Settling time of reference voltage (8) AVCC = AVCC (min) - AVCC(max) REFVSEL = {0, 1, 2}, REFON = 0 → 1 75 µs (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) 48 (5) ppm/ °C µA mV V The leakage current is defined in the leakage current table with P6.x/Ax parameter. The internal reference current is supplied from terminal AVCC. Consumption is independent of the ADC10ON control bit, unless a conversion is active. The REFON bit enables to settle the built-in reference before starting an A/D conversion. Calculated using the box method: (MAX(–40°C to 85°C) – MIN(–40°C to 85°C)) / MIN(–40°C to 85°C)/(85°C – (–40°C)). The sensor current ISENSOR is consumed if (ADC10ON = 1 and REFON = 1) or (ADC10ON = 1 and INCH = 0Ah and sample signal is high). When REFON = 1, ISENSOR is already included in IREF+. The temperature sensor offset can be significant. TI recommends a single-point calibration to minimize the offset error of the built-in temperature sensor. The typical equivalent impedance of the sensor is 51 kΩ. The sample time required includes the sensor-on time tSENSOR(on). The on-time tVMID(on) is included in the sampling time tVMID(sample); no additional on time is needed. The condition is that the error in a conversion started after tREFON is less than ±0.5 LSB. Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.46 Comparator_B over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER VCC TEST CONDITIONS VCC Supply voltage MIN TYP 1.8 3.6 1.8 V IAVCC_COMP VREF IAVCC_REF CBPWRMD = 00, CBON = 1, CBRSx = 00 Comparator operating supply current into AVCC, Excludes CBPWRMD = 01, CBON = 1, CBRSx = 00 reference resistor ladder Reference voltage level Quiescent current of resistor ladder into AVCC, Including REF module current VIC Common mode input range VOFFSET Input offset voltage CIN Input capacitance RSIN tPD tPD,filter Series input resistance Propagation delay, response time Propagation delay with filter active MAX V 38 2.2 V 31 38 3V 32 39 2.2 V, 3V 10 17 CBPWRMD = 10, CBON = 1, CBRSx = 00 2.2 V, 3V 0.2 0.85 CBREFLx = 01, CBREFACC = 0 ≥ 1.8V 1.44 ±2.5% CBREFLx = 10, CBREFACC = 0 ≥ 2.2V 1.92 ±2.5% CBREFLx = 11, CBREFACC = 0 ≥ 3.0V 2.39 ±2.5% CBREFACC = 1, CBREFLx = 01, CBRSx = 10, REFON = 0, CBON = 0 2.2 V, 3V 17 22 CBREFACC = 0, CBREFLx = 01, CBRSx = 10, REFON = 0, CBON = 0 2.2 V, 3V 33 40 µA V µA 0 VCC – 1 CBPWRMD = 00 –20 20 CBPWRMD = 01, 10 –10 10 5 ON - switch closed OFF - switch opened UNIT 3 V mV pF 4 50 kΩ MΩ CBPWRMD = 00, CBF = 0 450 CBPWRMD = 01, CBF = 0 600 CBPWRMD = 10, CBF = 0 50 ns µs CBPWRMD = 00, CBON = 1, CBF = 1, CBFDLY = 00 0.35 0.6 1.5 CBPWRMD = 00, CBON = 1, CBF = 1, CBFDLY = 01 0.6 1.0 1.8 CBPWRMD = 00, CBON = 1, CBF = 1, CBFDLY = 10 1.0 1.8 3.4 CBPWRMD = 00, CBON = 1, CBF = 1, CBFDLY = 11 1.8 3.4 6.5 1 2 µs 1.0 1.5 µs 50 ppm/ °C tEN_CMP Comparator enable time CBON = 0 to CBON = 1, CBPWRMD = 00, 01 tEN_REF Resistor reference enable time CBON = 0 to CBON = 1 TCCB_REF Temperature coefficient reference of VCB_REF VCB_REF Reference voltage for a given tap VIN = reference into resistor ladder, n = 0 to 31 µs VIN × (n+0.5) / 32 VIN × (n+1) / 32 VIN × (n+1.5) / 32 Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated V 49 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 5.47 Flash Memory over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) TEST CONDITIONS PARAMETER DVCC(PGM/ERASE) Program and erase supply voltage MIN TYP 1.8 MAX 3.6 UNIT V IPGM Average supply current from DVCC during program 3 5 mA IERASE Average supply current from DVCC during erase 6 11 mA IMERASE, IBANK Average supply current from DVCC during mass erase or bank erase 6 11 mA 16 ms tCPT Cumulative program time See (1) 4 Program and erase endurance 10 5 10 cycles tRetention Data retention duration TJ = 25°C tWord Word or byte program time See (2) 64 85 µs tBlock, 0 Block program time for first byte or word See (2) 49 65 µs tBlock, 1–(N–1) Block program time for each additional byte or word, except for last byte or word See (2) 37 49 µs Block program time for last byte or word See (2) 55 73 µs tErase Erase time for segment, mass erase, and bank erase when available See (2) 23 32 ms fMCLK,MRG MCLK frequency in marginal read mode (FCTL4.MRG0 = 1 or FCTL4. MRG1 = 1) 0 1 MHz tBlock, (1) (2) N 100 years The cumulative program time must not be exceeded when writing to a 128-byte flash block. This parameter applies to all programming methods: individual word or byte write mode and block write mode. These values are hardwired into the flash controller state machine. 5.48 JTAG and Spy-Bi-Wire Interface over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER VCC VIO MIN TYP MAX UNIT fSBW Spy-Bi-Wire input frequency 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 0 20 MHz tSBW,Low Spy-Bi-Wire low clock pulse duration 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 0.025 15 µs tSBW, En Spy-Bi-Wire enable time (TEST high to acceptance of first clock edge) (1) 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 1 µs tSBW,Rst Spy-Bi-Wire return to normal operation time 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 15 100 µs 2.2 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 0 5 MHz 3V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 0 10 MHz 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 45 80 kΩ fTCK TCK input frequency for 4-wire JTAG Rinternal (1) (2) 50 (2) Internal pulldown resistance on TEST 60 Tools that access the Spy-Bi-Wire interface must wait for the tSBW,En time after pulling the TEST/SBWTCK pin high before applying the first SBWTCK clock edge. fTCK may be restricted to meet the timing requirements of the module selected. Specifications Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 5.49 DVIO BSL Entry over recommended ranges of supply voltage and operating free-air temperature (unless otherwise noted) PARAMETER VCC VIO MIN TYP MAX UNIT tSU, BSLEN Setup time BSLEN to RST/NMI (1) 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 100 ns tHO, Hold time BSLEN to RST/NMI (2) 2.2 V, 3 V 1.62 V to 1.98 V 350 µs (1) (2) BSLEN AVCC, DVCC, DVIO stable and within specification. BSLEN must remain logically high long enough for the boot code to detect its level and enter the BSL sequence. After the minimum hold time is achieved, BSLEN is a don't care. BSLEN VIT+ VITtHO,BSLEN VIT+ VITRST/NMI (DVIO domain) tSU,BSLEN t Figure 5-18. DVIO BSL Entry Timing Specifications Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 51 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 6 Detailed Description 6.1 CPU (Link to user's guide) The MSP430 CPU has a 16-bit RISC architecture that is highly transparent to the application. All operations, other than program-flow instructions, are performed as register operations in conjunction with seven addressing modes for source operand and four addressing modes for destination operand. The CPU is integrated with 16 registers that provide reduced instruction execution time. The register-toregister operation execution time is one cycle of the CPU clock. Four of the registers, R0 to R3, are dedicated as program counter, stack pointer, status register, and constant generator, respectively. The remaining registers are general-purpose registers. Peripherals are connected to the CPU using data, address, and control buses and can be handled with all instructions. The instruction set consists of the original 51 instructions with three formats and seven address modes and additional instructions for the expanded address range. Each instruction can operate on word and byte data. Program Counter PC/R0 Stack Pointer SP/R1 Status Register Constant Generator 52 Detailed Description SR/CG1/R2 CG2/R3 General-Purpose Register R4 General-Purpose Register R5 General-Purpose Register R6 General-Purpose Register R7 General-Purpose Register R8 General-Purpose Register R9 General-Purpose Register R10 General-Purpose Register R11 General-Purpose Register R12 General-Purpose Register R13 General-Purpose Register R14 General-Purpose Register R15 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com 6.2 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Operating Modes The MSP430 has one active mode and six software selectable low-power modes of operation. An interrupt event can wake up the device from any of the low-power modes, service the request, and restore back to the low-power mode on return from the interrupt program. The following seven operating modes can be configured by software: • Active mode (AM) – All clocks are active • Low-power mode 0 (LPM0) – CPU is disabled – ACLK and SMCLK remain active, MCLK is disabled – FLL loop control remains active • Low-power mode 1 (LPM1) – CPU is disabled – FLL loop control is disabled – ACLK and SMCLK remain active, MCLK is disabled • Low-power mode 2 (LPM2) – CPU is disabled – MCLK, FLL loop control, and DCOCLK are disabled – DCO dc-generator remains enabled – ACLK remains active • Low-power mode 3 (LPM3) – CPU is disabled – MCLK, FLL loop control, and DCOCLK are disabled – DCO dc generator is disabled – ACLK remains active • Low-power mode 4 (LPM4) – CPU is disabled – ACLK is disabled – MCLK, FLL loop control, and DCOCLK are disabled – DCO dc generator is disabled – Crystal oscillator is stopped – Complete data retention • Low-power mode 4.5 (LPM4.5) – Internal regulator disabled – No data retention – Wakeup from RST/NMI, P1, and P2 Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 53 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.3 www.ti.com Interrupt Vector Addresses The interrupt vectors and the power-up start address are located in the address range 0FFFFh to 0FF80h. The vector contains the 16-bit address of the appropriate interrupt-handler instruction sequence. Table 6-1. Interrupt Sources, Flags, and Vectors INTERRUPT SOURCE INTERRUPT FLAG SYSTEM INTERRUPT WORD ADDRESS PRIORITY System Reset Power-Up External Reset Watchdog Time-out, Password Violation Flash Memory Password Violation PMM Password Violation WDTIFG, KEYV (SYSRSTIV) (1) (2) Reset 0FFFEh 63, highest System NMI PMM Vacant Memory Access JTAG Mailbox SVMLIFG, SVMHIFG, DLYLIFG, DLYHIFG, VLRLIFG, VLRHIFG, VMAIFG, JMBNIFG, JMBOUTIFG (SYSSNIV) (1) (Non)maskable 0FFFCh 62 User NMI NMI Oscillator Fault Flash Memory Access Violation NMIIFG, OFIFG, ACCVIFG, BUSIFG (SYSUNIV) (1) (2) (Non)maskable 0FFFAh 61 COMP_B Comparator B interrupt flags (CBIV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFF8h 60 TB0 Maskable 0FFF6h 59 TB0 TB0CCR1 CCIFG1 to TB0CCR6 CCIFG6, TB0IFG (TB0IV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFF4h 58 Watchdog Timer_A Interval Timer Mode WDTIFG Maskable 0FFF2h 57 USCI_A0 Receive or Transmit UCA0RXIFG, UCA0TXIFG (UCA0IV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFF0h 56 USCI_B0 Receive or Transmit UCB0RXIFG, UCB0TXIFG (UCB0IV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFEEh 55 ADC10_A (3) (4) 54 ADC10IFG0 (1) (3) (4) Maskable 0FFECh 54 TA0 TA0CCR0 CCIFG0 (3) Maskable 0FFEAh 53 TA0 TA0CCR1 CCIFG1 to TA0CCR4 CCIFG4, TA0IFG (TA0IV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFE8h 52 Reserved Reserved Maskable 0FFE6h 51 DMA DMA0IFG, DMA1IFG, DMA2IFG (DMAIV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFE4h 50 TA1 TA1CCR0 CCIFG0 (3) Maskable 0FFE2h 49 TA1 TA1CCR1 CCIFG1 to TA1CCR2 CCIFG2, TA1IFG (TA1IV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFE0h 48 I/O Port P1 (1) (2) TB0CCR0 CCIFG0 (3) P1IFG.0 to P1IFG.7 (P1IV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFDEh 47 USCI_A1 Receive or Transmit UCA1RXIFG, UCA1TXIFG (UCA1IV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFDCh 46 USCI_B1 Receive or Transmit (1) (3) Maskable 0FFDAh 45 TA2 UCB1RXIFG, UCB1TXIFG (UCB1IV) TA2CCR0 CCIFG0 (3) Maskable 0FFD8h 44 TA2 TA2CCR1 CCIFG1 to TA2CCR2 CCIFG2, TA2IFG (TA2IV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFD6h 43 I/O Port P2 P2IFG.0 to P2IFG.7 (P2IV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFD4h 42 RTC_A RTCRDYIFG, RTCTEVIFG, RTCAIFG, RT0PSIFG, RT1PSIFG (RTCIV) (1) (3) Maskable 0FFD2h 41 Multiple source flags A reset is generated if the CPU tries to fetch instructions from within peripheral space or vacant memory space. (Non)maskable: the individual interrupt-enable bit can disable an interrupt event, but the general-interrupt enable cannot disable it. Interrupt flags are located in the module. Only on devices with ADC, otherwise reserved Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 6-1. Interrupt Sources, Flags, and Vectors (continued) (5) INTERRUPT SOURCE INTERRUPT FLAG Reserved Reserved (5) SYSTEM INTERRUPT WORD ADDRESS PRIORITY 0FFD0h 40 ⋮ ⋮ 0FF80h 0, lowest Reserved interrupt vectors at addresses are not used in this device and can be used for regular program code if necessary. To maintain compatibility with other devices, TI recommends reserving these locations. 6.4 Memory Organization Table 6-2. Memory Organization (1) Memory (flash) Main: interrupt vector MSP430F5227 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5214 64KB 00FFFFh–00FF80h 128KB 00FFFFh–00FF80h N/A 32KB 0243FFh–01C400h N/A 32KB 01C3FFh–014400h Bank B 32KB 0143FFh–00C400h 32KB 0143FFh–00C400h Bank A 32KB 00C3FFh–004400h 32KB 00C3FFh–004400h Sector 3 2KB 0043FFh–003C00h 2KB 0043FFh–003C00h Sector 2 2KB 003BFFh–003400h 2KB 003BFFh–003400h Sector 1 2KB 0033FFh–002C00h 2KB 0033FFh–002C00h Sector 0 2KB 002BFFh–002400h 2KB 002BFFh–002400h A 128 B 001BFFh–001B80h 128 B 001BFFh–001B80h B 128 B 001B7Fh–001B00h 128 B 001B7Fh–001B00h C 128 B 001AFFh–001A80h 128 B 001AFFh–001A80h D 128 B 001A7Fh–001A00h 128 B 001A7Fh–001A00h Info A 128 B 0019FFh–001980h 128 B 0019FFh–001980h Info B 128 B 00197Fh–001900h 128 B 00197Fh–001900h Info C 128 B 0018FFh–001880h 128 B 0018FFh–001880h Info D 128 B 00187Fh–001800h 128 B 00187Fh–001800h Total Size Bank D Bank C Main: code memory RAM TI factory memory (ROM) Information memory (flash) (1) N/A = Not available Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 55 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-2. Memory Organization(1) (continued) Bootstrap loader (BSL) memory (flash) Peripherals 56 Detailed Description MSP430F5227 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5214 BSL 3 512 B 0017FFh–001600h 512 B 0017FFh–001600h BSL 2 512 B 0015FFh–001400h 512 B 0015FFh–001400h BSL 1 512 B 0013FFh–001200h 512 B 0013FFh–001200h BSL 0 512 B 0011FFh–001000h 512 B 0011FFh–001000h 4KB 000FFFh–0h 4KB 000FFFh–0h Size Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com 6.5 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Bootstrap Loader (BSL) The BSL enables users to program the flash memory or RAM using a UART serial interface. Access to the device memory by the BSL is protected by an user-defined password. Because the F522x and F521x have split I/O power domains, it is possible to interface with the BSL from either the DVCC or DVIO supply domains. This is useful when the MSP430 is interfacing to a host on the DVIO supply domain. The BSL interface on the DVIO supply domain (see Table 6-3) uses the USCI_A0 module configured as a UART. The BSL interface on the DVCC supply domain (see Table 6-4) uses a timer-based UART. NOTE Devices from TI come factory programmed with the timer-based UART BSL only. If the USCI-based BSL is preferred, it is also available, but it must be programmed by the user. When using the DVIO supply domain for the BSL, entry to the BSL requires a specific sequence on the RST/NMI and BSLEN pins. Table 6-3 shows the required pins and their functions. For further details on interfacing to development tools and device programmers, see the MSP430™ Hardware Tools User's Guide (SLAU278). For a complete description of the features of the BSL and its implementation, see the MSP430™ Programming Via the Bootstrap Loader User's Guide (SLAU319). The BSL on the DVIO supply domain uses the USCI_A0 module configured as a UART. NOTE To invoke the BSL from the DVIO domain, the RST/NMI and BSLEN pins must be used for the entry sequence (see Section 5.49). It is critical not to confuse the RST/NMI pin with the RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO pin. In other MSP430 devices, SBWTDIO is shared with the RST/NMI pin and RSTDVCC does not exist. Additional information can be found in Designing With MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x Devices (SLAA558). Table 6-3. DVIO BSL Pin Requirements and Functions DEVICE SIGNAL BSL FUNCTION RST/NMI External reset BSLEN Enable BSL P3.3 Data transmit P3.4 Data receive DVCC, AVCC Device power supply DVIO I/O power supply DVSS Ground supply For applications in which it is desirable to have BSL communication based on the DVCC supply domain, entry to the BSL requires a specific sequence on the RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO and TEST/SBWTCK pins. Table 6-4 shows the required pins and their function. NOTE To invoke the BSL from the DVCC domain, the RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO and TEST/SBWTCK pins must be used for the entry sequence. It is critical not to confuse the RST/NMI pin with the RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO pin. In other MSP430 devices, SBWTDIO is shared with the RST/NMI pin and RSTDVCC does not exist. Additional information can be found in Designing With MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x Devices (SLAA558). Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 57 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-4. DVCC BSL Pin Requirements and Functions 6.6 6.6.1 DEVICE SIGNAL BSL FUNCTION RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO External reset TEST/SBWTCK Enable BSL P1.1 Data transmit P1.2 Data receive DVCC, AVCC Device power supply DVIO I/O power supply DVSS Ground supply JTAG Operation JTAG Standard Interface The MSP430 family supports the standard JTAG interface which requires four signals for sending and receiving data. The JTAG signals are shared with general-purpose I/O. The TEST/SBWTCK pin is used to enable the JTAG signals. In addition to these signals, the RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO is required to interface with MSP430 development tools and device programmers. The JTAG pin requirements are shown in Table 6-5. For further details on interfacing to development tools and device programmers, see the MSP430™ Hardware Tools User's Guide (SLAU278). For a complete description of the features of the JTAG interface and its implementation, see MSP430™ Programming Via the JTAG Interface (SLAU320). Additional information can be found in Designing With MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x Devices (SLAA558). NOTE All JTAG I/O pins are supplied by DVCC. NOTE On other MSP430 devices, the RST/NMI pin has been used for SBWTDIO, so care must be taken not to mistakenly use the incorrect pin. On the F522x and F521x series of devices, RSTDVCC is used for SBWTDIO as shown in Table 6-5. Additional information can be found in Designing With MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x Devices (SLAA558). Table 6-5. JTAG Pin Requirements and Functions 58 DEVICE SIGNAL DIRECTION FUNCTION PJ.3/TCK IN JTAG clock input PJ.2/TMS IN JTAG state control PJ.1/TDI/TCLK IN JTAG data input, TCLK input PJ.0/TDO OUT JTAG data output TEST/SBWTCK IN Enable JTAG pins RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO IN Detailed Description External reset DVCC, AVCC Device power supply DVIO I/O power supply DVSS Ground supply Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com 6.6.2 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Spy-Bi-Wire Interface In addition to the standard JTAG interface, the MSP430 family supports the 2-wire Spy-Bi-Wire interface. Spy-Bi-Wire can be used to interface with MSP430 development tools and device programmers. The SpyBi-Wire interface pin requirements are shown in Table 6-6. For further details on interfacing to development tools and device programmers, see the MSP430™ Hardware Tools User's Guide (SLAU278). For a complete description of the features of the JTAG interface and its implementation, see MSP430 Programming Via the JTAG Interface (SLAU320).Additional information can be found in Designing With MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x Devices (SLAA558). NOTE All SBW I/O pins are supplied by DVCC. NOTE On other MSP430 devices, the RST/NMI pin has been used for SBWTDIO, so care must be taken not to mistakenly use the incorrect pin. On the F522x and F521x series of devices, RSTDVCC is used for SBWTDIO as shown in Table 6-6. Additional information can be found in Designing With MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x Devices (SLAA558). Table 6-6. Spy-Bi-Wire Pin Requirements and Functions DEVICE SIGNAL 6.7 DIRECTION FUNCTION TEST/SBWTCK IN Spy-Bi-Wire clock input RSTDVCC/SBWTDIO IN, OUT Spy-Bi-Wire data input/output DVCC, AVCC Device power supply DVIO I/O power supply DVSS Ground supply Flash Memory (Link to user's guide) The flash memory can be programmed through the JTAG port, Spy-Bi-Wire (SBW), the BSL, or in-system by the CPU. The CPU can perform single-byte, single-word, and long-word writes to the flash memory. Features of the flash memory include: • Flash memory has n segments of main memory and four segments of information memory (A to D) of 128 bytes each. Each segment in main memory is 512 bytes in size. • Segments 0 to n may be erased in one step, or each segment may be individually erased. • Segments A to D can be erased individually. Segments A to D are also called information memory. • Segment A can be locked separately. 6.8 RAM (Link to user's guide) The RAM is made up of n sectors. Each sector can be completely powered down to reduce leakage; however, all data is lost during power down. Features of the RAM include: • RAM has n sectors. The sizes of the sectors can be found in Section 6.4. • Each sector 0 to n can be complete disabled; however, all data in a sector is lost when it is disabled. • Each sector 0 to n automatically enters low-power retention mode when possible. Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 59 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.9 www.ti.com Peripherals Peripherals are connected to the CPU through data, address, and control buses. Peripherals can be managed using all instructions. For complete module descriptions, see the MSP430x5xx and MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide (SLAU208). 6.9.1 Digital I/O (Link to user's guide) • • • • • All individual I/O bits are independently programmable. Any combination of input, output, and interrupt conditions is possible. Pullup or pulldown on all ports is programmable. Drive strength on all ports is programmable. Edge-selectable interrupt and LPM4.5 wakeup input capability is available for all bits of ports P1 and P2. Read and write access to port-control registers is supported by all instructions. Ports can be accessed byte-wise or word-wise in pairs. • • 6.9.2 Port Mapping Controller (Link to user's guide) The port mapping controller allows the flexible and reconfigurable mapping of digital functions to port P4. Table 6-7. Port Mapping Mnemonics and Functions VALUE PxMAPy MNEMONIC INPUT PIN FUNCTION OUTPUT PIN FUNCTION 0 PM_NONE None DVSS PM_CBOUT0 - COMP_B output PM_TB0CLK TB0 clock input PM_ADC10CLK - PM_DMAE0 DMAE0 input 1 2 PM_SVMOUT - PM_TB0OUTH TB0 high-impedance input TB0OUTH 4 PM_TB0CCR0A TB0 CCR0 capture input CCI0A TB0 CCR0 compare output Out0 5 PM_TB0CCR1A TB0 CCR1 capture input CCI1A TB0 CCR1 compare output Out1 6 PM_TB0CCR2A TB0 CCR2 capture input CCI2A TB0 CCR2 compare output Out2 7 PM_TB0CCR3A TB0 CCR3 capture input CCI3A TB0 CCR3 compare output Out3 8 PM_TB0CCR4A TB0 CCR4 capture input CCI4A TB0 CCR4 compare output Out4 9 PM_TB0CCR5A TB0 CCR5 capture input CCI5A TB0 CCR5 compare output Out5 10 PM_TB0CCR6A TB0 CCR6 capture input CCI6A TB0 CCR6 compare output Out6 3 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 60 ADC10CLK SVM output PM_UCA1RXD USCI_A1 UART RXD (direction controlled by USCI - input) PM_UCA1SOMI USCI_A1 SPI slave out master in (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCA1TXD USCI_A1 UART TXD (direction controlled by USCI - output) PM_UCA1SIMO USCI_A1 SPI slave in master out (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCA1CLK USCI_A1 clock input/output (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB1STE USCI_B1 SPI slave transmit enable (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB1SOMI USCI_B1 SPI slave out master in (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB1SCL USCI_B1 I2C clock (open drain and direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB1SIMO USCI_B1 SPI slave in master out (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB1SDA USCI_B1 I2C data (open drain and direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB1CLK USCI_B1 clock input/output (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCA1STE USCI_A1 SPI slave transmit enable (direction controlled by USCI) PM_CBOUT1 None 18 PM_MCLK None MCLK 19 PM_RTCCLK None RTCCLK output Detailed Description COMP_B output Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 6-7. Port Mapping Mnemonics and Functions (continued) VALUE 20 21 22 23 24 25 PxMAPy MNEMONIC OUTPUT PIN FUNCTION USCI_A0 UART RXD (direction controlled by USCI - input) PM_UCA0SOMI USCI_A0 SPI slave out master in (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCA0TXD USCI_A0 UART TXD (direction controlled by USCI - output) PM_UCA0SIMO USCI_A0 SPI slave in master out (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCA0CLK USCI_A0 clock input/output (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB0STE USCI_B0 SPI slave transmit enable (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB0SOMI USCI_B0 SPI slave out master in (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB0SCL USCI_B0 I2C clock (open drain and direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB0SIMO USCI_B0 SPI slave in master out (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB0SDA USCI_B0 I2C data (open drain and direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCB0CLK USCI_B0 clock input/output (direction controlled by USCI) PM_UCA0STE USCI_A0 SPI slave transmit enable (direction controlled by USCI) 26 - 30 Reserved 31 (0FFh) (1) (1) INPUT PIN FUNCTION PM_UCA0RXD None DVSS Disables the output driver and the input Schmitt trigger to prevent parasitic cross currents when applying analog signals PM_ANALOG The value of the PM_ANALOG mnemonic is set to 0FFh. The port mapping registers are only 5 bits wide and the upper bits are ignored resulting in a read out value of 31. Table 6-8. Default Mapping (1) PIN PxMAPy MNEMONIC INPUT PIN FUNCTION OUTPUT PIN FUNCTION P4.0/P4MAP0 PM_UCB1STE/PM_UCA1CLK USCI_B1 SPI slave transmit enable (direction controlled by USCI) USCI_A1 clock input/output (direction controlled by USCI) P4.1/P4MAP1 PM_UCB1SIMO/PM_UCB1SDA USCI_B1 SPI slave in master out (direction controlled by USCI) USCI_B1 I2C data (open drain and direction controlled by USCI) P4.2/P4MAP2 PM_UCB1SOMI/PM_UCB1SCL USCI_B1 SPI slave out master in (direction controlled by USCI) USCI_B1 I2C clock (open drain and direction controlled by USCI) P4.3/P4MAP3 PM_UCB1CLK/PM_UCA1STE USCI_A1 SPI slave transmit enable (direction controlled by USCI) USCI_B1 clock input/output (direction controlled by USCI) P4.4/P4MAP4 PM_UCA1TXD/PM_UCA1SIMO USCI_A1 UART TXD (Direction controlled by USCI - output) USCI_A1 SPI slave in master out (direction controlled by USCI) P4.5/P4MAP5 PM_UCA1RXD/PM_UCA1SOMI USCI_A1 UART RXD (Direction controlled by USCI - input) USCI_A1 SPI slave out master in (direction controlled by USCI) P4.6/P4MAP6 PM_NONE None DVSS P4.7/P4MAP7 (1) PM_NONE None DVSS Not available on all devices Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 61 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.9.3 www.ti.com Oscillator and System Clock (Link to user's guide) The clock system in the MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x family of devices is supported by the Unified Clock System (UCS) module, which includes support for a 32-kHz watch crystal oscillator (XT1 LF mode) (XT1 HF mode is not supported), an internal very-low-power low-frequency oscillator (VLO), an internal trimmed low-frequency oscillator (REFO), an integrated internal digitally controlled oscillator (DCO), and a high-frequency crystal oscillator (XT2). The UCS module is designed to meet the requirements of both low system cost and low power consumption. The UCS module features digital frequency locked loop (FLL) hardware that, in conjunction with a digital modulator, stabilizes the DCO frequency to a programmable multiple of the selected FLL reference frequency. The internal DCO provides a fast turnon clock source and stabilizes in 3.5 µs (typical). The UCS module provides the following clock signals: • Auxiliary clock (ACLK), sourced from a 32-kHz watch crystal (XT1), a high-frequency crystal (XT2), the internal low-frequency oscillator (VLO), the trimmed low-frequency oscillator (REFO), or the internal digitally controlled oscillator DCO. • Main clock (MCLK), the system clock used by the CPU. MCLK can be sourced by same sources made available to ACLK. • Sub-Main clock (SMCLK), the subsystem clock used by the peripheral modules. SMCLK can be sourced by same sources made available to ACLK. • ACLK/n, the buffered output of ACLK, ACLK/2, ACLK/4, ACLK/8, ACLK/16, ACLK/32. 6.9.4 Power-Management Module (PMM) (Link to user's guide) The PMM includes an integrated voltage regulator that supplies the core voltage to the device and contains programmable output levels to provide for power optimization. The PMM also includes supply voltage supervisor (SVS) and supply voltage monitoring (SVM) circuitry, and brownout protection. The brownout circuit is implemented to provide the proper internal reset signal to the device during power-on and power-off. The SVS and SVM circuitry detects if the supply voltage drops below a user-selectable level and supports both supply voltage supervision (the device is automatically reset) and supply voltage monitoring (the device is not automatically reset). SVS and SVM circuitry is available on the primary supply and core supply. 6.9.5 Hardware Multiplier (Link to user's guide) The multiplication operation is supported by a dedicated peripheral module. The module performs operations with 32-bit, 24-bit, 16-bit, and 8-bit operands. The module is capable of supporting signed and unsigned multiplication as well as signed and unsigned multiply and accumulate operations. 6.9.6 Real-Time Clock (RTC_A) (Link to user's guide) The RTC_A module can be used as a general-purpose 32-bit counter (counter mode) or as an integrated real-time clock (RTC) (calendar mode). In counter mode, the RTC_A also includes two independent 8-bit timers that can be cascaded to form a 16-bit timer or counter. Both timers can be read and written by software. Calendar mode integrates an internal calendar that compensates for months with less than 31 days and includes leap year correction. The RTC_A also supports flexible alarm functions and offsetcalibration hardware. 6.9.7 Watchdog Timer (WDT_A) (Link to user's guide) The primary function of the WDT_A module is to perform a controlled system restart after a software problem occurs. If the selected time interval expires, a system reset is generated. If the watchdog function is not needed in an application, the module can be configured as an interval timer and can generate interrupts at selected time intervals. 62 Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com 6.9.8 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 System Module (SYS) (Link to user's guide) The SYS module handles many of the system functions within the device. These include power-on reset (POR) and power-up clear (PUC) handling, NMI source selection and management, reset interrupt vector generators, bootstrap loader (BSL) entry mechanisms, and configuration management (device descriptors). It also includes a data exchange mechanism when using JTAG that is called a JTAG mailbox and that can be used in the application. Table 6-9. System Module Interrupt Vector Registers INTERRUPT VECTOR REGISTER SYSRSTIV, System Reset SYSSNIV, System NMI SYSUNIV, User NMI ADDRESS 019Eh 019Ch 019Ah INTERRUPT EVENT VALUE No interrupt pending 00h Brownout (BOR) 02h RST/NMI (BOR) 04h PMMSWBOR (BOR) 06h Wakeup from LPMx.5 08h Security violation (BOR) 0Ah SVSL (POR) 0Ch SVSH (POR) 0Eh SVML_OVP (POR) 10h SVMH_OVP (POR) 12h PMMSWPOR (POR) 14h WDT time-out (PUC) 16h WDT password violation (PUC) 18h KEYV flash password violation (PUC) 1Ah Reserved 1Ch Peripheral area fetch (PUC) 1Eh PMM password violation (PUC) 20h Reserved 22h to 3Eh No interrupt pending 00h SVMLIFG 02h SVMHIFG 04h SVSMLDLYIFG 06h SVSMHDLYIFG 08h VMAIFG 0Ah JMBINIFG 0Ch JMBOUTIFG 0Eh SVMLVLRIFG 10h SVMHVLRIFG 12h Reserved 14h to 1Eh No interrupt pending 00h NMIIFG 02h OFIFG 04h ACCVIFG 06h Reserved 08h Reserved 0Ah to 1Eh PRIORITY Highest Lowest Highest Lowest Highest Lowest Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 63 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.9.9 www.ti.com DMA Controller (Link to user's guide) The DMA controller allows movement of data from one memory address to another without CPU intervention. For example, the DMA controller can be used to move data from the ADC10_A conversion memory to RAM. Using the DMA controller can increase the throughput of peripheral modules. The DMA controller reduces system power consumption by allowing the CPU to remain in sleep mode, without having to awaken to move data to or from a peripheral. Table 6-10. DMA Trigger Assignments (1) TRIGGER (1) (2) 64 CHANNEL 0 1 2 0 DMAREQ DMAREQ DMAREQ 1 TA0CCR0 CCIFG TA0CCR0 CCIFG TA0CCR0 CCIFG 2 TA0CCR2 CCIFG TA0CCR2 CCIFG TA0CCR2 CCIFG 3 TA1CCR0 CCIFG TA1CCR0 CCIFG TA1CCR0 CCIFG 4 TA1CCR2 CCIFG TA1CCR2 CCIFG TA1CCR2 CCIFG 5 TA2CCR0 CCIFG TA2CCR0 CCIFG TA2CCR0 CCIFG 6 TA2CCR2 CCIFG TA2CCR2 CCIFG TA2CCR2 CCIFG 7 TB0CCR0 CCIFG TB0CCR0 CCIFG TB0CCR0 CCIFG 8 TB0CCR2 CCIFG TB0CCR2 CCIFG TB0CCR2 CCIFG 9 Reserved Reserved Reserved 10 Reserved Reserved Reserved 11 Reserved Reserved Reserved 12 Reserved Reserved Reserved 13 Reserved Reserved Reserved 14 Reserved Reserved Reserved 15 Reserved Reserved Reserved 16 UCA0RXIFG UCA0RXIFG UCA0RXIFG 17 UCA0TXIFG UCA0TXIFG UCA0TXIFG 18 UCB0RXIFG UCB0RXIFG UCB0RXIFG 19 UCB0TXIFG UCB0TXIFG UCB0TXIFG 20 UCA1RXIFG UCA1RXIFG UCA1RXIFG 21 UCA1TXIFG UCA1TXIFG UCA1TXIFG 22 UCB1RXIFG UCB1RXIFG UCB1RXIFG 23 UCB1TXIFG UCB1TXIFG UCB1TXIFG (2) ADC10IFG0 (2) ADC10IFG0 (2) 24 ADC10IFG0 25 Reserved Reserved Reserved 26 Reserved Reserved Reserved 27 Reserved Reserved Reserved 28 Reserved Reserved Reserved 29 MPY ready MPY ready MPY ready 30 DMA2IFG DMA0IFG DMA1IFG 31 DMAE0 DMAE0 DMAE0 If a reserved trigger source is selected, no trigger is generated. Only on devices with ADC; reserved on devices without ADC Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.9.10 Universal Serial Communication Interface (USCI) (Links to user's guide: UART Mode, SPI Mode, I2C Mode) The USCI modules are used for serial data communication. The USCI module supports synchronous communication protocols such as SPI (3 or 4 pin) and I2C, and asynchronous communication protocols such as UART, enhanced UART with automatic baudrate detection, and IrDA. Each USCI module contains two portions, A and B. The USCI_An module provides support for SPI (3-pin or 4-pin), UART, enhanced UART, or IrDA. The USCI_Bn module provides support for SPI (3-pin or 4-pin) or I2C. The MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x series include two complete USCI modules (n = 0, 1). Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 65 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 6.9.11 TA0 (Link to user's guide) TA0 is a 16-bit timer/counter (Timer_A type) with five capture/compare registers. TA0 can support multiple captures or compares, PWM outputs, and interval timing. It also has extensive interrupt capabilities. Interrupts may be generated from the counter on overflow conditions and from each of the capture/compare registers. Table 6-11. TA0 Signal Connections INPUT PIN NUMBER RGC, ZQE, YFF 18, H2, B2P1.0 RGZ DEVICE INPUT SIGNAL MODULE INPUT SIGNAL 13-P1.0 TA0CLK TACLK ACLK (internal) ACLK SMCLK (internal) SMCLK 18, H2, B2P1.0 13-P1.0 TA0CLK TACLK 19, H3, B3P1.1 14-P1.1 TA0.0 CCI0A DVSS CCI0B DVSS GND DVCC VCC TA0.1 CCI1A CBOUT (internal) CCI1B 20, J3, A3P1.2 21, G4, C3P1.3 22, H4, D3P1.4 23, J4, A4P1.5 66 15-P1.2 16-P1.3 17-P1.4 18-P1.5 Detailed Description DVSS GND DVCC VCC TA0.2 CCI2A ACLK (internal) CCI2B DVSS GND DVCC VCC TA0.3 CCI3A DVSS CCI3B DVSS GND DVCC VCC TA0.4 CCI4A DVSS CCI4B DVSS GND DVCC VCC MODULE BLOCK MODULE OUTPUT SIGNAL DEVICE OUTPUT SIGNAL Timer NA NA CCR0 CCR1 CCR2 CCR3 CCR4 TA0 TA1 TA2 TA3 TA4 OUTPUT PIN NUMBER RGC, ZQE, YFF RGZ 19, H3, B3-P1.1 14-P1.1 20, J3, A3-P1.2 15-P1.2 ADC10 (internal) ADC10SHSx = {1} ADC10 (internal) ADC10SHSx = {1} 21, G4, C3-P1.3 16-P1.3 22, H4, D3-P1.4 17-P1.4 23, J4, A4-P1.5 18-P1.5 TA0.0 TA0.1 TA0.2 TA0.3 TA0.4 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.9.12 TA1 (Link to user's guide) TA1 is a 16-bit timer/counter (Timer_A type) with three capture/compare registers. TA1 can support multiple captures or compares, PWM outputs, and interval timing. It also has extensive interrupt capabilities. Interrupts may be generated from the counter on overflow conditions and from each of the capture/compare registers. Table 6-12. TA1 Signal Connections INPUT PIN NUMBER RGC, ZQE, YFF 24, G5, B4P1.6 RGZ DEVICE INPUT SIGNAL MODULE INPUT SIGNAL 19-P1.6 TA1CLK TACLK ACLK (internal) ACLK SMCLK (internal) SMCLK 24, G5, B4P1.6 19-P1.6 TA1CLK TACLK 25, H5, C4P1.7 20-P1.7 TA1.0 CCI0A DVSS CCI0B DVSS GND DVCC VCC TA1.1 CCI1A CBOUT (internal) CCI1B DVSS GND DVCC VCC TA1.2 CCI2A ACLK (internal) CCI2B DVSS GND DVCC VCC 26, J5, A5P2.0 27, G6, D4P2.1 MODULE BLOCK MODULE OUTPUT SIGNAL DEVICE OUTPUT SIGNAL Timer NA NA CCR0 TA0 OUTPUT PIN NUMBER RGC, ZQE, YFF RGZ 25, H5, C4P1.7 20-P1.7 TA1.0 26, J5, A5P2.0 CCR1 TA1 TA1.1 27, G6, D4P2.1 CCR2 TA2 TA1.2 Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 67 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 6.9.13 TA2 (Link to user's guide) TA2 is a 16-bit timer/counter (Timer_A type) with three capture/compare registers. TA2 can support multiple captures or compares, PWM outputs, and interval timing. It also has extensive interrupt capabilities. Interrupts may be generated from the counter on overflow conditions and from each of the capture/compare registers. Table 6-13. TA2 Signal Connections INPUT PIN NUMBER DEVICE INPUT SIGNAL MODULE INPUT SIGNAL TA2CLK TACLK ACLK (internal) ACLK SMCLK (internal) SMCLK 28, J6, B5P2.2 TA2CLK TACLK 29, H6, A6P2.3 TA2.0 CCI0A DVSS CCI0B DVSS GND DVCC VCC TA2.1 CCI1A CBOUT (internal) CCI1B DVSS GND DVCC VCC TA2.2 CCI2A ACLK (internal) CCI2B DVSS GND DVCC VCC RGC, ZQE, YFF RGZ 28, J6, B5P2.2 30, J7, C5P2.4 31, J8, B6P2.5 68 Detailed Description MODULE BLOCK MODULE OUTPUT SIGNAL DEVICE OUTPUT SIGNAL Timer NA NA OUTPUT PIN NUMBER RGC, ZQE, YFF RGZ 29, H6, A6P2.3 CCR0 TA0 TA2.0 30, J7, C5P2.4 CCR1 TA1 TA2.1 31, J8, B6P2.5 CCR2 TA2 TA2.2 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.9.14 TB0 (Link to user's guide) TB0 is a 16-bit timer/counter (Timer_B type) with seven capture/compare registers. TB0 can support multiple captures or compares, PWM outputs, and interval timing. It also has extensive interrupt capabilities. Interrupts may be generated from the counter on overflow conditions and from each of the capture/compare registers. Table 6-14. TB0 Signal Connections INPUT PIN NUMBER DEVICE INPUT SIGNAL MODULE INPUT SIGNAL TB0CLK TBCLK ACLK (internal) ACLK SMCLK (internal) SMCLK (1) TB0CLK TBCLK 49, B8(9), H8P7.0 (1) (1) TB0.0 CCI0A 49, B8(9), H8P7.0 (1) (1) TB0.0 CCI0B RGC, ZQE, YFF (1) RGZ (1) (1) 50, A9, G7P7.1 (1) (1) DVSS GND DVCC VCC TB0.1 CCI1A CBOUT (internal) CCI1B DVSS GND DVCC VCC 51, B7, F6P7.2 (1) (1) TB0.2 CCI2A 51, B7, F6P7.2 (1) (1) TB0.2 CCI2B DVSS GND DVCC VCC 52, A8, H7P7.3 (1) (1) TB0.3 CCI3A 52, A8, H7P7.3 (1) (1) TB0.3 CCI3B DVSS GND DVCC VCC 53, A7, G6P7.4 (1) (1) TB0.4 CCI4A 53, A7, G6P7.4 (1) (1) TB0.4 CCI4B GND VCC 54, A6, H6P7.5 (1) (1) TB0.5 CCI5A 54, A6, H6P7.5 (1) (1) TB0.5 CCI5B DVSS GND (1) (1) DVSS DVCC (1) DVCC VCC TB0.6 CCI6A ACLK (internal) CCI6B DVSS GND DVCC VCC MODULE BLOCK MODULE OUTPUT SIGNAL DEVICE OUTPUT SIGNAL Timer NA NA CCR0 CCR1 CCR2 CCR3 CCR4 CCR5 CCR6 TB0 TB1 TB2 TB3 TB4 TB5 TB6 TB0.0 TB0.1 OUTPUT PIN NUMBER RGC, ZQE, YFF RGZ 49, B8(9), H8P7.0 (1) (1) ADC10 (internal) ADC10SHSx = {2} ADC10 (internal) ADC10SHSx = {2} 50, A9, G7-P7.1 (1) (1) ADC10 (internal) ADC10SHSx = {3} ADC10 (internal) ADC10SHSx = {3} 51, B7, F6-P7.2 (1) (1) 52, A8, H7-P7.3 (1) (1) 53, A7, G6-P7.4 (1) (1) 54, A6, H6-P7.5 (1) (1) (1) (1) TB0.2 TB0.3 TB0.4 TB0.5 TB0.6 Timer functions can be assigned by the port mapping controller. Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 69 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 6.9.15 Comparator_B (Link to user's guide) The primary function of the Comparator_B module is to support precision slope analog-to-digital conversions, battery voltage supervision, and monitoring of external analog signals. 6.9.16 ADC10_A (Link to user's guide) The ADC10_A module supports fast 10-bit analog-to-digital conversions. The module implements a 10-bit SAR core, sample select control, reference generator, and a conversion result buffer. A window comparator with lower and upper limits allows CPU-independent result monitoring with three window comparator interrupt flags. 6.9.17 CRC16 (Link to user's guide) The CRC16 module produces a signature based on a sequence of entered data values and can be used for data checking purposes. The CRC16 module signature is based on the CRC-CCITT standard. 6.9.18 REF Voltage Reference (Link to user's guide) The REF is responsible for generation of all critical reference voltages that can be used by the various analog peripherals in the device. 6.9.19 Embedded Emulation Module (EEM) (S Version) (Link to user's guide) The EEM supports real-time in-system debugging. The S version of the EEM has the following features: • Three hardware triggers or breakpoints on memory access • One hardware trigger or breakpoint on CPU register write access • Up to four hardware triggers can be combined to form complex triggers or breakpoints • One cycle counter • Clock control on module level 70 Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.9.20 Peripheral File Map Table 6-15. Peripherals MODULE NAME BASE ADDRESS OFFSET ADDRESS RANGE Special Functions (see Table 6-16) 0100h 000h-01Fh PMM (see Table 6-17) 0120h 000h-010h Flash Control (see Table 6-18) 0140h 000h-00Fh CRC16 (see Table 6-19) 0150h 000h-007h RAM Control (see Table 6-20) 0158h 000h-001h Watchdog (see Table 6-21) 015Ch 000h-001h UCS (see Table 6-22) 0160h 000h-01Fh SYS (see Table 6-23) 0180h 000h-01Fh Shared Reference (see Table 6-24) 01B0h 000h-001h Port Mapping Control (see Table 6-25) 01C0h 000h-002h Port Mapping Port P4 (see Table 6-25) 01E0h 000h-007h Port P1, P2 (see Table 6-26) 0200h 000h-01Fh Port P3, P4 (see Table 6-27) 0220h 000h-00Bh Port P5, P6 (see Table 6-28) 0240h 000h-00Bh Port P7 (see Table 6-29) 0260h 000h-00Bh Port PJ (see Table 6-30) 0320h 000h-01Fh TA0 (see Table 6-31) 0340h 000h-02Eh TA1 (see Table 6-32) 0380h 000h-02Eh TB0 (see Table 6-33) 03C0h 000h-02Eh TA2 (see Table 6-34) 0400h 000h-02Eh Real-Time Clock (RTC_A) (see Table 6-35) 04A0h 000h-01Bh 32-Bit Hardware Multiplier (see Table 6-36) 04C0h 000h-02Fh DMA General Control (see Table 6-37) 0500h 000h-00Fh DMA Channel 0 (see Table 6-37) 0510h 000h-00Ah DMA Channel 1 (see Table 6-37) 0520h 000h-00Ah DMA Channel 2 (see Table 6-37) 0530h 000h-00Ah USCI_A0 (see Table 6-38) 05C0h 000h-01Fh USCI_B0 (see Table 6-39) 05E0h 000h-01Fh USCI_A1 (see Table 6-40) 0600h 000h-01Fh USCI_B1 (see Table 6-41) 0620h 000h-01Fh ADC10_A (see Table 6-42) 0740h 000h-01Fh Comparator_B (see Table 6-43) 08C0h 000h-00Fh Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 71 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-16. Special Function Registers (Base Address: 0100h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET SFR interrupt enable SFRIE1 00h SFR interrupt flag SFRIFG1 02h SFR reset pin control SFRRPCR 04h Table 6-17. PMM Registers (Base Address: 0120h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET PMM Control 0 PMMCTL0 00h PMM control 1 PMMCTL1 02h SVS high side control SVSMHCTL 04h SVS low side control SVSMLCTL 06h PMM interrupt flags PMMIFG 0Ch PMM interrupt enable PMMIE 0Eh PMM power mode 5 control PM5CTL0 10h Table 6-18. Flash Control Registers (Base Address: 0140h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Flash control 1 FCTL1 00h Flash control 3 FCTL3 04h Flash control 4 FCTL4 06h Table 6-19. CRC16 Registers (Base Address: 0150h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET CRC data input CRC16DI 00h CRC data input reverse byte CRCDIRB 02h CRC initialization and result CRCINIRES 04h CRC result reverse byte CRCRESR 06h Table 6-20. RAM Control Registers (Base Address: 0158h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION RAM control 0 REGISTER RCCTL0 OFFSET 00h Table 6-21. Watchdog Registers (Base Address: 015Ch) REGISTER DESCRIPTION Watchdog timer control REGISTER WDTCTL OFFSET 00h Table 6-22. UCS Registers (Base Address: 0160h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET UCS control 0 UCSCTL0 00h UCS control 1 UCSCTL1 02h UCS control 2 UCSCTL2 04h UCS control 3 UCSCTL3 06h UCS control 4 UCSCTL4 08h UCS control 5 UCSCTL5 0Ah UCS control 6 UCSCTL6 0Ch UCS control 7 UCSCTL7 0Eh 72 Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 6-22. UCS Registers (Base Address: 0160h) (continued) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET UCS control 8 UCSCTL8 10h UCS control 9 UCSCTL9 12h Table 6-23. SYS Registers (Base Address: 0180h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET System control SYSCTL 00h Bootstrap loader configuration area SYSBSLC 02h JTAG mailbox control SYSJMBC 06h JTAG mailbox input 0 SYSJMBI0 08h JTAG mailbox input 1 SYSJMBI1 0Ah JTAG mailbox output 0 SYSJMBO0 0Ch JTAG mailbox output 1 SYSJMBO1 0Eh User NMI vector generator SYSUNIV 1Ah System NMI vector generator SYSSNIV 1Ch Reset vector generator SYSRSTIV 1Eh Table 6-24. Shared Reference Registers (Base Address: 01B0h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION Shared reference control REGISTER REFCTL OFFSET 00h Table 6-25. Port Mapping Registers (Base Address of Port Mapping Control: 01C0h, Port P4: 01E0h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Port mapping key/ID register PMAPKEYID 00h Port mapping control register PMAPCTL 02h Port P4.0 mapping register P4MAP0 00h Port P4.1 mapping register P4MAP1 01h Port P4.2 mapping register P4MAP2 02h Port P4.3 mapping register P4MAP3 03h Port P4.4 mapping register P4MAP4 04h Port P4.5 mapping register P4MAP5 05h Port P4.6 mapping register P4MAP6 06h Port P4.7 mapping register P4MAP7 07h Table 6-26. Port P1, P2 Registers (Base Address: 0200h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Port P1 input P1IN 00h Port P1 output P1OUT 02h Port P1 direction P1DIR 04h Port P1 pullup or pulldown enable P1REN 06h Port P1 drive strength P1DS 08h Port P1 selection P1SEL 0Ah Port P1 interrupt vector word P1IV 0Eh Port P1 interrupt edge select P1IES 18h Port P1 interrupt enable P1IE 1Ah Port P1 interrupt flag P1IFG 1Ch Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 73 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-26. Port P1, P2 Registers (Base Address: 0200h) (continued) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Port P2 input P2IN 01h Port P2 output P2OUT 03h Port P2 direction P2DIR 05h Port P2 pullup or pulldown enable P2REN 07h Port P2 drive strength P2DS 09h Port P2 selection P2SEL 0Bh Port P2 interrupt vector word P2IV 1Eh Port P2 interrupt edge select P2IES 19h Port P2 interrupt enable P2IE 1Bh Port P2 interrupt flag P2IFG 1Dh Table 6-27. Port P3, P4 Registers (Base Address: 0220h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Port P3 input P3IN 00h Port P3 output P3OUT 02h Port P3 direction P3DIR 04h Port P3 pullup or pulldown enable P3REN 06h Port P3 drive strength P3DS 08h Port P3 selection P3SEL 0Ah Port P4 input P4IN 01h Port P4 output P4OUT 03h Port P4 direction P4DIR 05h Port P4 pullup or pulldown enable P4REN 07h Port P4 drive strength P4DS 09h Port P4 selection P4SEL 0Bh Table 6-28. Port P5, P6 Registers (Base Address: 0240h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Port P5 input P5IN 00h Port P5 output P5OUT 02h Port P5 direction P5DIR 04h Port P5 pullup or pulldown enable P5REN 06h Port P5 drive strength P5DS 08h Port P5 selection P5SEL 0Ah Port P6 input P6IN 01h Port P6 output P6OUT 03h Port P6 direction P6DIR 05h Port P6 pullup or pulldown enable P6REN 07h Port P6 drive strength P6DS 09h Port P6 selection P6SEL 0Bh Table 6-29. Port P7 Registers (Base Address: 0260h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Port P7 input P7IN 00h Port P7 output P7OUT 02h Port P7 direction P7DIR 04h 74 Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 6-29. Port P7 Registers (Base Address: 0260h) (continued) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Port P7 pullup or pulldown enable P7REN 06h Port P7 drive strength P7DS 08h Port P7 selection P7SEL 0Ah Table 6-30. Port J Registers (Base Address: 0320h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Port PJ input PJIN 00h Port PJ output PJOUT 02h Port PJ direction PJDIR 04h Port PJ pullup or pulldown enable PJREN 06h Port PJ drive strength PJDS 08h Table 6-31. TA0 Registers (Base Address: 0340h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET TA0 control TA0CTL 00h Capture/compare control 0 TA0CCTL0 02h Capture/compare control 1 TA0CCTL1 04h Capture/compare control 2 TA0CCTL2 06h Capture/compare control 3 TA0CCTL3 08h Capture/compare control 4 TA0CCTL4 0Ah TA0 counter register TA0R 10h Capture/compare register 0 TA0CCR0 12h Capture/compare register 1 TA0CCR1 14h Capture/compare register 2 TA0CCR2 16h Capture/compare register 3 TA0CCR3 18h Capture/compare register 4 TA0CCR4 1Ah TA0 expansion register 0 TA0EX0 20h TA0 interrupt vector TA0IV 2Eh Table 6-32. TA1 Registers (Base Address: 0380h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET TA1 control TA1CTL 00h Capture/compare control 0 TA1CCTL0 02h Capture/compare control 1 TA1CCTL1 04h Capture/compare control 2 TA1CCTL2 06h TA1 counter register TA1R 10h Capture/compare register 0 TA1CCR0 12h Capture/compare register 1 TA1CCR1 14h Capture/compare register 2 TA1CCR2 16h TA1 expansion register 0 TA1EX0 20h TA1 interrupt vector TA1IV 2Eh Table 6-33. TB0 Registers (Base Address: 03C0h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET TB0 control TB0CTL 00h Capture/compare control 0 TB0CCTL0 02h Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 75 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-33. TB0 Registers (Base Address: 03C0h) (continued) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Capture/compare control 1 TB0CCTL1 04h Capture/compare control 2 TB0CCTL2 06h Capture/compare control 3 TB0CCTL3 08h Capture/compare control 4 TB0CCTL4 0Ah Capture/compare control 5 TB0CCTL5 0Ch Capture/compare control 6 TB0CCTL6 0Eh TB0 register TB0R 10h Capture/compare register 0 TB0CCR0 12h Capture/compare register 1 TB0CCR1 14h Capture/compare register 2 TB0CCR2 16h Capture/compare register 3 TB0CCR3 18h Capture/compare register 4 TB0CCR4 1Ah Capture/compare register 5 TB0CCR5 1Ch Capture/compare register 6 TB0CCR6 1Eh TB0 expansion register 0 TB0EX0 20h TB0 interrupt vector TB0IV 2Eh Table 6-34. TA2 Registers (Base Address: 0400h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET TA2 control TA2CTL 00h Capture/compare control 0 TA2CCTL0 02h Capture/compare control 1 TA2CCTL1 04h Capture/compare control 2 TA2CCTL2 06h TA2 counter register TA2R 10h Capture/compare register 0 TA2CCR0 12h Capture/compare register 1 TA2CCR1 14h Capture/compare register 2 TA2CCR2 16h TA2 expansion register 0 TA2EX0 20h TA2 interrupt vector TA2IV 2Eh Table 6-35. Real-Time Clock Registers (Base Address: 04A0h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET RTC control 0 RTCCTL0 00h RTC control 1 RTCCTL1 01h RTC control 2 RTCCTL2 02h RTC control 3 RTCCTL3 03h RTC prescaler 0 control RTCPS0CTL 08h RTC prescaler 1 control RTCPS1CTL 0Ah RTC prescaler 0 RTCPS0 0Ch RTC prescaler 1 RTCPS1 0Dh RTC interrupt vector word RTCIV 0Eh RTC seconds/counter register 1 RTCSEC/RTCNT1 10h RTC minutes/counter register 2 RTCMIN/RTCNT2 11h RTC hours/counter register 3 RTCHOUR/RTCNT3 12h RTC day of week/counter register 4 RTCDOW/RTCNT4 13h RTC days RTCDAY 14h RTC month RTCMON 15h 76 Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 6-35. Real-Time Clock Registers (Base Address: 04A0h) (continued) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET RTC year low RTCYEARL 16h RTC year high RTCYEARH 17h RTC alarm minutes RTCAMIN 18h RTC alarm hours RTCAHOUR 19h RTC alarm day of week RTCADOW 1Ah RTC alarm days RTCADAY 1Bh Table 6-36. 32-Bit Hardware Multiplier Registers (Base Address: 04C0h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET 16-bit operand 1 – multiply MPY 00h 16-bit operand 1 – signed multiply MPYS 02h 16-bit operand 1 – multiply accumulate MAC 04h 16-bit operand 1 – signed multiply accumulate MACS 06h 16-bit operand 2 OP2 08h 16 × 16 result low word RESLO 0Ah 16 × 16 result high word RESHI 0Ch 16 × 16 sum extension register SUMEXT 0Eh 32-bit operand 1 – multiply low word MPY32L 10h 32-bit operand 1 – multiply high word MPY32H 12h 32-bit operand 1 – signed multiply low word MPYS32L 14h 32-bit operand 1 – signed multiply high word MPYS32H 16h 32-bit operand 1 – multiply accumulate low word MAC32L 18h 32-bit operand 1 – multiply accumulate high word MAC32H 1Ah 32-bit operand 1 – signed multiply accumulate low word MACS32L 1Ch 32-bit operand 1 – signed multiply accumulate high word MACS32H 1Eh 32-bit operand 2 – low word OP2L 20h 32-bit operand 2 – high word OP2H 22h 32 × 32 result 0 – least significant word RES0 24h 32 × 32 result 1 RES1 26h 32 × 32 result 2 RES2 28h 32 × 32 result 3 – most significant word RES3 2Ah MPY32 control register 0 MPY32CTL0 2Ch Table 6-37. DMA Registers (Base Address DMA General Control: 0500h, DMA Channel 0: 0510h, DMA Channel 1: 0520h, DMA Channel 2: 0530h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET DMA channel 0 control DMA0CTL 00h DMA channel 0 source address low DMA0SAL 02h DMA channel 0 source address high DMA0SAH 04h DMA channel 0 destination address low DMA0DAL 06h DMA channel 0 destination address high DMA0DAH 08h DMA channel 0 transfer size DMA0SZ 0Ah DMA channel 1 control DMA1CTL 00h DMA channel 1 source address low DMA1SAL 02h DMA channel 1 source address high DMA1SAH 04h DMA channel 1 destination address low DMA1DAL 06h DMA channel 1 destination address high DMA1DAH 08h Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 77 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-37. DMA Registers (Base Address DMA General Control: 0500h, DMA Channel 0: 0510h, DMA Channel 1: 0520h, DMA Channel 2: 0530h) (continued) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET DMA channel 1 transfer size DMA1SZ 0Ah DMA channel 2 control DMA2CTL 00h DMA channel 2 source address low DMA2SAL 02h DMA channel 2 source address high DMA2SAH 04h DMA channel 2 destination address low DMA2DAL 06h DMA channel 2 destination address high DMA2DAH 08h DMA channel 2 transfer size DMA2SZ 0Ah DMA module control 0 DMACTL0 00h DMA module control 1 DMACTL1 02h DMA module control 2 DMACTL2 04h DMA module control 3 DMACTL3 06h DMA module control 4 DMACTL4 08h DMA interrupt vector DMAIV 0Eh Table 6-38. USCI_A0 Registers (Base Address: 05C0h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET USCI control 1 UCA0CTL1 00h USCI control 0 UCA0CTL0 01h USCI baud rate 0 UCA0BR0 06h USCI baud rate 1 UCA0BR1 07h USCI modulation control UCA0MCTL 08h USCI status UCA0STAT 0Ah USCI receive buffer UCA0RXBUF 0Ch USCI transmit buffer UCA0TXBUF 0Eh USCI LIN control UCA0ABCTL 10h USCI IrDA transmit control UCA0IRTCTL 12h USCI IrDA receive control UCA0IRRCTL 13h USCI interrupt enable UCA0IE 1Ch USCI interrupt flags UCA0IFG 1Dh USCI interrupt vector word UCA0IV 1Eh Table 6-39. USCI_B0 Registers (Base Address: 05E0h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET USCI synchronous control 1 UCB0CTL1 00h USCI synchronous control 0 UCB0CTL0 01h USCI synchronous bit rate 0 UCB0BR0 06h USCI synchronous bit rate 1 UCB0BR1 07h USCI synchronous status UCB0STAT 0Ah USCI synchronous receive buffer UCB0RXBUF 0Ch USCI synchronous transmit buffer UCB0TXBUF 0Eh USCI I2C own address UCB0I2COA 10h USCI I2C slave address UCB0I2CSA 12h USCI interrupt enable UCB0IE 1Ch USCI interrupt flags UCB0IFG 1Dh USCI interrupt vector word UCB0IV 1Eh 78 Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 6-40. USCI_A1 Registers (Base Address: 0600h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET USCI control 1 UCA1CTL1 00h USCI control 0 UCA1CTL0 01h USCI baud rate 0 UCA1BR0 06h USCI baud rate 1 UCA1BR1 07h USCI modulation control UCA1MCTL 08h USCI status UCA1STAT 0Ah USCI receive buffer UCA1RXBUF 0Ch USCI transmit buffer UCA1TXBUF 0Eh USCI LIN control UCA1ABCTL 10h USCI IrDA transmit control UCA1IRTCTL 12h USCI IrDA receive control UCA1IRRCTL 13h USCI interrupt enable UCA1IE 1Ch USCI interrupt flags UCA1IFG 1Dh USCI interrupt vector word UCA1IV 1Eh Table 6-41. USCI_B1 Registers (Base Address: 0620h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET USCI synchronous control 1 UCB1CTL1 00h USCI synchronous control 0 UCB1CTL0 01h USCI synchronous bit rate 0 UCB1BR0 06h USCI synchronous bit rate 1 UCB1BR1 07h USCI synchronous status UCB1STAT 0Ah USCI synchronous receive buffer UCB1RXBUF 0Ch USCI synchronous transmit buffer UCB1TXBUF 0Eh USCI I2C own address UCB1I2COA 10h USCI I2C slave address UCB1I2CSA 12h USCI interrupt enable UCB1IE 1Ch USCI interrupt flags UCB1IFG 1Dh USCI interrupt vector word UCB1IV 1Eh Table 6-42. ADC10_A Registers (Base Address: 0740h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET ADC10_A Control register 0 ADC10CTL0 00h ADC10_A Control register 1 ADC10CTL1 02h ADC10_A Control register 2 ADC10CTL2 04h ADC10_A Window Comparator Low Threshold ADC10LO 06h ADC10_A Window Comparator High Threshold ADC10HI 08h ADC10_A Memory Control Register 0 ADC10MCTL0 0Ah ADC10_A Conversion Memory Register ADC10MEM0 12h ADC10_A Interrupt Enable ADC10IE 1Ah ADC10_A Interrupt Flags ADC10IGH 1Ch ADC10_A Interrupt Vector Word ADC10IV 1Eh Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 79 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-43. Comparator_B Registers (Base Address: 08C0h) REGISTER DESCRIPTION REGISTER OFFSET Comp_B control register 0 CBCTL0 00h Comp_B control register 1 CBCTL1 02h Comp_B control register 2 CBCTL2 04h Comp_B control register 3 CBCTL3 06h Comp_B interrupt register CBINT 0Ch Comp_B interrupt vector word CBIV 0Eh 80 Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.10 Input/Output Schematics 6.10.1 Port P1, P1.0 to P1.7, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic P1REN.x P1DIR.x 0 From module 1 P1OUT.x 0 From module 1 0 (P1.0 to P1.3) DVCC (P1.4 to P1.7) DVIO 1 1 Direction 0: Input 1: Output P1DS.x 0: Low drive 1: High drive P1SEL.x P1IN.x EN To module DVSS P1.0/TA0CLK/ACLK P1.1/TA0.0 P1.2/TA0.1 P1.3/TA0.2 P1.4/TA0.3 P1.5/TA0.4 P1.6/TA1CLK/CBOUT P1.7/TA1.0 D P1IE.x EN P1IRQ.x Q P1IFG.x P1SEL.x P1IES.x Set Interrupt Edge Select Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 81 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-44. Port P1 (P1.0 to P1.7) Pin Functions PIN NAME (P1.x) P1.0/TA0CLK/ACLK x 0 FUNCTION P1DIR.x P1SEL.x P1.0 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 TA0CLK 0 1 ACLK P1.1/TA0.0 1 P1.1 (I/O) TA0.CCI0A TA0.0 P1.2/TA0.1 2 P1.2 (I/O) TA0.CCI1A TA0.1 P1.3/TA0.2 P1.4/TA0.3 P1.5/TA0.4 P1.6/TA1CLK/CBOUT P1.7/TA1.0 82 Detailed Description 3 4 5 6 7 CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS 1 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 0 1 1 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 0 1 1 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 TA0.CCI2A 0 1 TA0.2 1 1 P1.3 (I/O) P1.4 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 TA0.CCI3A 0 1 TA0.3 1 1 P1.5 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 TA0.CCI4A 0 1 TA0.4 1 1 P1.6 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 TA1CLK 0 1 CBOUT comparator B 1 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 TA1.CCI0A 0 1 TA1.0 1 1 P1.7 (I/O) Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.10.2 Port P2, P2.0 to P2.7, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic P2REN.x P2DIR.x 0 From module 1 P2OUT.x 0 From module 1 0 DVIO 1 1 Direction 0: Input 1: Output P2DS.x 0: Low drive 1: High drive P2SEL.x P2IN.x EN To module DVSS P2.0/TA1.1 P2.1/TA1.2 P2.2/TA2CLK/SMCLK P2.3/TA2.0 P2.4/TA2.1 P2.5/TA2.2 P2.6/RTCCLK/DMAE0 P2.7/UB0STE/UCA0CLK D P2IE.x EN To module Q P2IFG.x P2SEL.x P2IES.x Set Interrupt Edge Select Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 83 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-45. Port P2 (P2.0 to P2.7) Pin Functions PIN NAME (P2.x) P2.0/TA1.1 (2) x 0 FUNCTION P2.0 (I/O) TA1.CCI1A TA1.1 P2.1/TA1.2 (2) 1 P2.1 (I/O) TA1.CCI2A TA1.2 P2.2/TA2CLK/SMCLK (2) 2 P2.4/TA2.1 P2.5/TA2.2 3 (2) 4 (2) P2.6/RTCCLK/DMAE0 5 (2) P2.7/UCB0STE/UCA0CLK 6 7 84 P2SEL.x 0 0 1 1 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 0 1 1 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 TA2CLK 0 1 1 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 TA2.CCI0A 0 1 TA2.0 1 1 P2.3 (I/O) P2.4 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 TA2.CCI1A 0 1 TA2.1 1 1 P2.5 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 TA2.CCI2A 0 1 TA2.2 1 1 P2.6 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 DMAE0 0 1 RTCCLK 1 1 P2.7 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 X 1 UCB0STE/UCA0CLK (1) (2) (3) (4) P2DIR.x I: 0; O: 1 P2.2 (I/O) SMCLK P2.3/TA2.0 (2) CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS (1) (3) (4) X = Don't care Not available on RGZ package types. The pin direction is controlled by the USCI module. UCA0CLK function takes precedence over UCB0STE function. If the pin is required as UCA0CLK input or output, USCI_B0 is forced to 3-wire SPI mode if 4-wire SPI mode is selected. Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.10.3 Port P3, P3.0 to P3.4, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic P3REN.x P3DIR.x 0 From module 1 P3OUT.x 0 From module 1 DVSS 0 DVIO 1 1 Direction 0: Input 1: Output P3DS.x 0: Low drive 1: High drive P3SEL.x P3IN.x P3.0/UCB0SIMO/UCB0SDA P3.1/UCB0SOMI/UCB0SCL P3.2/UCB0CLK/UCA0STE P3.3/UCA0TXD/UCA0SIMO P3.4/UCA0RXD/UCA0SOMI EN To module D Table 6-46. Port P3 (P3.0 to P3.4) Pin Functions PIN NAME (P3.x) x P3.0/UCB0SIMO/UCB0SDA 0 FUNCTION P3.0 (I/O) UCB0SIMO/UCB0SDA (2) P3.1/UCB0SOMI/UCB0SCL 1 P3.1 (I/O) UCB0SOMI/UCB0SCL P3.2/UCB0CLK/UCA0STE 2 (2) (3) P3.2 (I/O) UCB0CLK/UCA0STE (2) P3.3/UCA0TXD/UCA0SIMO 3 4 (4) P3.3 (I/O) UCA0TXD/UCA0SIMO P3.4/UCA0RXD/UCA0SOMI (2) P3.4 (I/O) UCA0RXD/UCA0SOMI (2) (1) (2) (3) (4) (3) CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS (1) P3DIR.x P3SEL.x I: 0; O: 1 0 X 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 X 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 X 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 X 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 X 1 X = Don't care The pin direction is controlled by the USCI module. If the I2C functionality is selected, the output drives only the logical 0 to VSS level. UCB0CLK function takes precedence over UCA0STE function. If the pin is required as UCB0CLK input or output, USCI_A0 is forced to 3-wire SPI mode if 4-wire SPI mode is selected. Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 85 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 6.10.4 Port P4, P4.0 to P4.7, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic P4REN.x P4DIR.x 0 from Port Mapping Control 1 P4OUT.x 0 from Port Mapping Control 1 DVSS 0 DVIO 1 1 Direction 0: Input 1: Output P4.0/P4MAP0 P4.1/P4MAP1 P4.2/P4MAP2 P4.3/P4MAP3 P4.4/P4MAP4 P4.5/P4MAP5 P4.6/P4MAP6 P4.7/P4MAP7 P4DS.x 0: Low drive 1: High drive P4SEL.x P4IN.x EN D to Port Mapping Control Table 6-47. Port P4 (P4.0 to P4.7) Pin Functions PIN NAME (P4.x) P4.0/P4MAP0 x 0 FUNCTION P4.0 (I/O) Mapped secondary digital function P4.1/P4MAP1 1 P4.1 (I/O) Mapped secondary digital function P4.2/P4MAP2 2 P4.3/P4MAP3 3 P4.2 (I/O) Mapped secondary digital function P4.3 (I/O) Mapped secondary digital function P4.4/P4MAP4 4 P4.4 (I/O) Mapped secondary digital function P4.5/P4MAP5 5 P4.5 (I/O) Mapped secondary digital function P4.6/P4MAP6 6 P4.6 (I/O) Mapped secondary digital function P4.7/P4MAP7 (3) 7 P4.7 (I/O) Mapped secondary digital function (1) (2) (3) 86 CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS (1) P4DIR.x (2) P4SEL.x I: 0; O: 1 0 X X 1 ≤ 30 I: 0; O: 1 0 X X 1 ≤ 30 I: 0; O: 1 0 X ≤ 30 P4MAPx X 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 X X 1 ≤ 30 I: 0; O: 1 0 X X 1 ≤ 30 I: 0; O: 1 0 X X 1 ≤ 30 I: 0; O: 1 0 X X 1 ≤ 30 I: 0; O: 1 0 X X 1 ≤ 30 X = Don't care The direction of some mapped secondary functions are controlled directly by the module. See Table 6-7 for specific direction control information of mapped secondary functions. Not available on RGZ package types. Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.10.5 Port P5, P5.0 and P5.1, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic to/from Reference (n/a MSP430F521x) (n/a MSPF430F521x) to ADC10 (n/a MSPF430F521x) INCHx = x P5REN.x P5DIR.x DVSS 0 DVCC 1 1 0 1 P5OUT.x 0 From module 1 P5.0/(A8/VeREF+) P5.1/(A9/VeREF–) P5DS.x 0: Low drive 1: High drive P5SEL.x P5IN.x Bus Keeper EN To module D Table 6-48. Port P5 (P5.0 and P5.1) Pin Functions PIN NAME (P5.x) P5.0/A8/VeREF+ x 0 FUNCTION P5.0 (I/O) (3) A8/VeREF+ (4) P5.1/A9/VeREF– 1 P5.1 (I/O) (3) A9/VeREF– (5) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS (1) P5DIR.x P5SEL.x REFOUT (2) I: 0; O: 1 0 X X 1 0 I: 0; O: 1 0 X X 1 0 X = Don't care REFOUT resides in the REF module. Default condition Setting the P5SEL.0 bit disables the output driver and the input Schmitt trigger to prevent parasitic cross currents when applying analog signals. An external voltage can be applied to VeREF+ and used as the reference for the ADC10_A. Channel A8, when selected with the INCHx bits, is connected to the VeREF+ pin. Setting the P5SEL.1 bit disables the output driver and the input Schmitt trigger to prevent parasitic cross currents when applying analog signals. An external voltage can be applied to VeREF- and used as the reference for the ADC10_A. Channel A9, when selected with the INCHx bits, is connected to the VeREF- pin. Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 87 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 6.10.6 Port P5, P5.2, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic To XT2 P5REN.2 P5DIR.2 DVSS 0 DVCC 1 1 0 1 P5OUT.2 0 Module X OUT 1 P5DS.2 0: Low drive 1: High drive P5SEL.2 P5.2/XT2IN P5IN.2 EN Module X IN 88 Detailed Description Bus Keeper D Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.10.7 Port P5, P5.3, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic To XT2 P5REN.3 P5DIR.3 DVSS 0 DVCC 1 1 0 1 P5OUT.3 0 Module X OUT 1 P5SEL.2 P5.3/XT2OUT P5DS.3 0: Low drive 1: High drive XT2BYPASS P5SEL.3 P5IN.3 Bus Keeper EN Module X IN D Table 6-49. Port P5 (P5.2 and P5.3) Pin Functions PIN NAME (P5.x) P5.2/XT2IN x 2 FUNCTION P5DIR.x P5SEL.2 P5SEL.3 XT2BYPASS I: 0; O: 1 0 X X X 1 X 0 X 1 X 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 0 X XT2OUT crystal mode (3) X 1 X 0 P5.3 (I/O) (3) X 1 0 1 P5.2 (I/O) XT2IN crystal mode (2) XT2IN bypass mode (2) P5.3/XT2OUT (1) (2) (3) 3 CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS (1) P5.3 (I/O) X = Don't care Setting P5SEL.2 causes the general-purpose I/O to be disabled. Pending the setting of XT2BYPASS, P5.2 is configured for crystal mode or bypass mode. Setting P5SEL.2 causes the general-purpose I/O to be disabled in crystal mode. When using bypass mode, P5.3 can be used as general-purpose I/O. Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 89 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 6.10.8 Port P5, P5.4 and P5.5 Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic to XT1 P5REN.4 P5DIR.4 DVSS 0 DVCC 1 1 0 1 P5OUT.4 0 Module X OUT 1 P5DS.4 0: Low drive 1: High drive P5SEL.4 P5.4/XIN P5IN.4 EN Module X IN 90 Detailed Description Bus Keeper D Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Pad Logic to XT1 P5REN.5 P5DIR.5 DVSS 0 DVCC 1 1 0 1 P5OUT.5 0 Module X OUT 1 P5.5/XOUT P5SEL.4 P5DS.5 0: Low drive 1: High drive XT1BYPASS P5SEL.5 P5IN.5 Bus Keeper EN Module X IN D Table 6-50. Port P5 (P5.4 and P5.5) Pin Functions PIN NAME (P5.x) P5.4/XIN 4 P5.5/XOUT (1) (2) (3) x 5 FUNCTION P5.4 (I/O) CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS (1) P5DIR.x P5SEL.4 P5SEL.5 XT1BYPASS I: 0; O: 1 0 X X XIN crystal mode (2) X 1 X 0 XIN bypass mode (2) X 1 X 1 P5.5 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 0 X XOUT crystal mode (3) X 1 X 0 P5.5 (I/O) (3) X 1 0 1 X = Don't care Setting P5SEL.4 causes the general-purpose I/O to be disabled. Pending the setting of XT1BYPASS, P5.4 is configured for crystal mode or bypass mode. Setting P5SEL.4 causes the general-purpose I/O to be disabled in crystal mode. When using bypass mode, P5.5 can be used as general-purpose I/O. Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 91 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 6.10.9 Port P6, P6.0 to P6.7, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic to ADC10 (n/a MSPF430F521x) INCHx = x (n/a MSPF430F521x) to Comparator_B from Comparator_B CBPD.x P6REN.x P6DIR.x 0 0 From module 1 0 DVCC 1 P6DS.x 0: Low drive 1: High drive P6SEL.x P6IN.x EN To module 92 Detailed Description 1 Direction 0: Input 1: Output 1 P6OUT.x DVSS D Bus Keeper P6.0/CB0/(A0) P6.1/CB1/(A1) P6.2/CB2/(A2) P6.3/CB3/(A3) P6.4/CB4/(A4) P6.5/CB5/(A5) P6.6/CB6/(A6) P6.7/CB7/(A7) Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 6-51. Port P6 (P6.0 to P6.7) Pin Functions PIN NAME (P6.x) P6.0/CB0/(A0) x 0 FUNCTION P6.0 (I/O) A0 CB0 (1) P6.1/CB1/(A1) 1 P6.1 (I/O) A1 CB1 (1) P6.2/CB2/(A2) 2 P6.2 (I/O) A2 CB2 (1) P6.3/CB3/(A3) 3 P6.4/CB4/(A4) 4 P6.5/CB5/(A5) P6.6/CB6/(A6) 5 (2) 6 (1) (2) 0 CBPD 0 X 1 X 1 X X I: 0; O: 1 0 0 X 1 X 1 X X I: 0; O: 1 0 0 X 1 X 1 X X 0 0 A3 X 1 X CB3 (1) X X 1 P6.4 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 0 A4 X 1 X CB4 (1) X X 1 P6.5 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 0 A5 X 1 X CB5 (1) X X 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 0 X 1 X X X 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 0 P6.6 (I/O) CB6 (1) 7 P6SEL.x I: 0; O: 1 I: 0; O: 1 P6.3 (I/O) A6 P6.7/CB7/(A7) (2) CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS P6DIR.x P6.7 (I/O) A7 X 1 X CB7 (1) X X 1 Setting the CBPD.x bit disables the output driver and the input Schmitt trigger to prevent parasitic cross currents when applying analog signals. Selecting the CBx input pin to the comparator multiplexer with the CBx bits automatically disables output driver and input buffer for that pin, regardless of the state of the associated CBPD.x bit. Not available on RGZ package types. Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 93 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 6.10.10 Port P7, P7.0 to P7.5, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger Pad Logic P7REN.x P7DIR.x 0 From module 1 P7OUT.x 0 DVSS 0 DVIO 1 1 Direction 0: Input 1: Output 1 P7.0/TB0.0 P7.1/TB0.1 P7.2/TB0.2 P7.3/TB0.3 P7.4/TB0.4 P7.5/TB0.5 P7DS.x 0: Low drive 1: High drive P7SEL.x P7IN.x EN D To module Table 6-52. Port P7 (P7.0 to P7.5) Pin Functions PIN NAME (P7.x) P7.0/TB0.0 (1) x 0 FUNCTION P7.0 (I/O) TB0.CCI0A TB0.0 P7.1/TB0.1 (1) 1 P7.1 (I/O) TB0.CCI1A TB0.1 P7.2/TB0.2 (1) P7.3/TB0.3 P7.4/TB0.4 P7.5/TB0.5 (1) 94 (1) (1) (1) 2 3 4 5 CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS P7DIR.x P7SEL.x I: 0; O: 1 0 0 1 1 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 0 1 1 1 I: 0; O: 1 0 TB0.CCI2A 0 1 TB0.2 1 1 P7.2 (I/O) P7.3 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 TB0.CCI3A 0 1 TB0.3 1 1 P7.4 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 TB0.CCI4A 0 1 TB0.4 1 1 P7.5 (I/O) I: 0; O: 1 0 TB0.CCI5A 0 1 TB0.5 1 1 Not available on RGZ package types. Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.10.11 Port J, J.0 JTAG pin TDO, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger or Output Pad Logic PJREN.0 PJDIR.0 0 DVCC 1 PJOUT.0 0 From JTAG 1 DVSS 0 DVCC 1 1 PJ.0/TDO PJDS.0 0: Low drive 1: High drive From JTAG PJIN.0 EN D 6.10.12 Port J, J.1 to J.3 JTAG pins TMS, TCK, TDI/TCLK, Input/Output With Schmitt Trigger or Output Pad Logic PJREN.x PJDIR.x 0 DVSS 1 PJOUT.x 0 From JTAG 1 DVSS 0 DVCC 1 PJDS.x 0: Low drive 1: High drive From JTAG 1 PJ.1/TDI/TCLK PJ.2/TMS PJ.3/TCK PJIN.x EN To JTAG D Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 95 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-53. Port PJ (PJ.0 to PJ.3) Pin Functions PIN NAME (PJ.x) x CONTROL BITS OR SIGNALS (1) FUNCTION PJDIR.x PJ.0/TDO 0 PJ.0 (I/O) (2) I: 0; O: 1 TDO (3) PJ.1/TDI/TCLK 1 X PJ.1 (I/O) (2) TDI/TCLK (3) PJ.2/TMS 2 PJ.2 (I/O) TMS (3) PJ.3/TCK 3 96 (4) X (2) I: 0; O: 1 (4) X PJ.3 (I/O) (2) TCK (3) (1) (2) (3) (4) I: 0; O: 1 I: 0; O: 1 (4) X X = Don't care Default condition The pin direction is controlled by the JTAG module. In JTAG mode, pullups are activated automatically on TMS, TCK, and TDI/TCLK. PJREN.x are do not care. Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 6.11 Device Descriptors Table 6-54 and Table 6-55 list the complete contents of the device descriptor tag-length-value (TLV) structure for each device type. Table 6-54. MSP430F522x Device Descriptor Table (1) Info Block Die Record ADC10 Calibration REF Calibration Peripheral Descriptor (1) DESCRIPTION ADDRESS SIZE (BYTES) F5229 F5227 F5224 F5222 VALUE VALUE VALUE VALUE Info length 01A00h 1 06h 06h 06h 06h CRC length 01A01h 1 06h 06h 06h 06h CRC value 01A02h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit Device ID 01A04h 1 51h 4Fh 4Ch 4Ah Device ID 01A05h 1 81h 81h 81h 81h Hardware revision 01A06h 1 per unit per unit per unit per unit Firmware revision 01A07h 1 per unit per unit per unit per unit Die Record Tag 01A08h 1 08h 08h 08h 08h Die Record length 01A09h 1 0Ah 0Ah 0Ah 0Ah Lot/Wafer ID 01A0Ah 4 per unit per unit per unit per unit Die X position 01A0Eh 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit Die Y position 01A10h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit Test results 01A12h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit ADC10 Calibration Tag 01A14h 1 13h 13h 13h 13h ADC10 Calibration length 01A15h 1 10h 10h 10h 10h ADC Gain Factor 01A16h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit ADC Offset 01A18h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit ADC 1.5-V Reference Temp. Sensor 30°C 01A1Ah 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit ADC 1.5-V Reference Temp. Sensor 85°C 01A1Ch 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit ADC 2.0-V Reference Temp. Sensor 30°C 01A1Eh 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit ADC 2.0-V Reference Temp. Sensor 85°C 01A20h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit ADC 2.5-V Reference Temp. Sensor 30°C 01A22h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit ADC 2.5-V Reference Temp. Sensor 85°C 01A24h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit REF Calibration Tag 01A26h 1 12h 12h 12h 12h REF Calibration length 01A27h 1 06h 06h 06h 06h REF 1.5-V Reference Factor 01A28h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit REF 2.0-V Reference Factor 01A2Ah 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit REF 2.5-V Reference Factor 01A2Ch 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit Peripheral Descriptor Tag 01A2Eh 1 02h 02h 02h 02h Peripheral Descriptor Length 01A2Fh 1 5Fh 5Fh 5Dh 5Dh Memory 1 2 08h 8Ah 08h 8Ah 08h 8Ah 08h 8Ah Memory 2 2 0Ch 86h 0Ch 86h 0Ch 86h 0Ch 86h Memory 3 2 12h 2Eh 12h 2Eh 12h 2Eh 12h 2Eh NA = Not applicable, blank = unused and reads FFh. Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 97 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-54. MSP430F522x Device Descriptor Table(1) (continued) DESCRIPTION 98 Detailed Description ADDRESS SIZE (BYTES) F5229 F5227 F5224 F5222 VALUE VALUE VALUE VALUE Memory 4 2 22h 96h 22h 94h 22h 96h 22h 94h Memory 5 2 N/A N/A N/A N/A Memory 6 1/2 N/A N/A N/A N/A delimiter 1 00h 00h 00h 00h Peripheral count 1 20h 20h 1Fh 1Fh MSP430CPUXV2 2 00h 23h 00h 23h 00h 23h 00h 23h JTAG 2 00h 09h 00h 09h 00h 09h 00h 09h SBW 2 00h 0Fh 00h 0Fh 00h 0Fh 00h 0Fh EEM-S 2 00h 03h 00h 03h 00h 03h 00h 05h TI BSL 2 00h FCh 00h FCh 00h FCh 00h FCh SFR 2 10h 41h 10h 41h 10h 41h 10h 41h PMM 2 02h 30h 02h 30h 02h 30h 02h 30h FCTL 2 02h 38h 02h 38h 02h 38h 02h 38h CRC16 2 01h 3Ch 01h 3Ch 01h 3Ch 01h 3Ch CRC16_RB 2 00h 3Dh 00h 3Dh 00h 3Dh 00h 3Dh RAMCTL 2 00h 44h 00h 44h 00h 44h 00h 44h WDT_A 2 00h 40h 00h 40h 00h 40h 00h 40h UCS 2 01h 48h 01h 48h 01h 48h 01h 48h SYS 2 02h 42h 02h 42h 02h 42h 02h 42h REF 2 03h A0h 03h A0h 03h A0h 03h A0h Port Mapping 2 01h 10h 01h 10h 01h 10h 01h 10h Port 1/2 2 04h 51h 04h 51h 04h 51h 04h 51h Port 3/4 2 02h 52h 02h 52h 02h 52h 02h 52h Port 5/6 2 02h 53h 02h 53h 02h 53h 02h 53h Port 7/8 2 02h 54h 02h 54h N/A N/A JTAG 2 0Ch 5Fh 0Ch 5Fh 0Eh 5Fh 0Eh 5Fh TA0 2 02h 62h 02h 62h 02h 62h 02h 62h TA1 2 04h 61h 04h 61h 04h 61h 04h 61h TB0 2 04h 67h 04h 67h 04h 67h 04h 67h Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 6-54. MSP430F522x Device Descriptor Table(1) (continued) DESCRIPTION Interrupts ADDRESS SIZE (BYTES) F5229 F5227 F5224 F5222 VALUE VALUE VALUE VALUE TA2 2 04h 61h 04h 61h 04h 61h 04h 61h RTC 2 0Ah 68h 0Ah 68h 0Ah 68h 0Ah 68h MPY32 2 02h 85h 02h 85h 02h 85h 02h 85h DMA-3 2 04h 47h 04h 47h 04h 47h 04h 47h USCI_A/B 2 0Ch 90h 0Ch 90h 0Ch 90h 0Ch 90h USCI_A/B 2 04h 90h 04h 90h 04h 90h 04h 90h ADC10_A 2 14h D3h 14h D3h 14h D3h 14h D3h COMP_B 2 18h A8h 18h A8h 18h A8h 18h A8h COMP_B 1 A8h A8h A8h A8h TB0.CCIFG0 1 64h 64h 64h 64h TB0.CCIFG1..6 1 65h 65h 65h 65h WDTIFG 1 40h 40h 40h 40h USCI_A0 1 90h 90h 90h 90h USCI_B0 1 91h 91h 91h 91h ADC10_A 1 D0h D0h D0h D0h TA0.CCIFG0 1 60h 60h 60h 60h TA0.CCIFG1..4 1 61h 61h 61h 61h Reserved 1 01h 01h 01h 01h DMA 1 46h 46h 46h 46h TA1.CCIFG0 1 62h 62h 62h 62h TA1.CCIFG1..2 1 63h 63h 63h 63h P1 1 50h 50h 50h 50h USCI_A1 1 92h 92h 92h 92h USCI_B1 1 93h 93h 93h 93h TA1.CCIFG0 1 66h 66h 66h 66h TA1.CCIFG1..2 1 67h 67h 67h 67h P2 1 51h 51h 51h 51h RTC_A 1 68h 68h 68h 68h delimiter 1 00h 00h 00h 00h Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 99 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-55. MSP430F521x Device Descriptor Table (1) Info Block REF Calibration Peripheral Descriptor (1) 100 ADDRESS SIZE (BYTES) F5219 F5217 F5214 F5212 VALUE VALUE VALUE VALUE Info length 01A00h 1 06h 06h 06h 06h CRC length 01A01h 1 06h 06h 06h 06h CRC value 01A02h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit Device ID 01A04h 1 47h 45h 42h 40h Device ID 01A05h 1 81h 81h 81h 81h Hardware revision 01A06h 1 per unit per unit per unit per unit Firmware revision 01A07h 1 per unit per unit per unit per unit Die Record Tag 01A08h 1 08h 08h 08h 08h Die Record length 01A09h 1 0Ah 0Ah 0Ah 0Ah Lot/Wafer ID 01A0Ah 4 per unit per unit per unit per unit Die X position 01A0Eh 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit Die Y position 01A10h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit Test results 01A12h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit ADC10 Calibration Tag 01A14h 1 13h 13h 13h 13h ADC10 Calibration length 01A15h 1 10h 10h 10h 10h ADC Gain Factor 01A16h 2 blank blank blank blank Die Record ADC10 Calibration DESCRIPTION ADC Offset 01A18h 2 blank blank blank blank ADC 1.5-V Reference Temp. Sensor 30°C 01A1Ah 2 blank blank blank blank ADC 1.5-V Reference Temp. Sensor 85°C 01A1Ch 2 blank blank blank blank ADC 2.0-V Reference Temp. Sensor 30°C 01A1Eh 2 blank blank blank blank ADC 2.0-V Reference Temp. Sensor 85°C 01A20h 2 blank blank blank blank ADC 2.5-V Reference Temp. Sensor 30°C 01A22h 2 blank blank blank blank ADC 2.5-V Reference Temp. Sensor 85°C 01A24h 2 blank blank blank blank 12h REF Calibration Tag 01A26h 1 12h 12h 12h REF Calibration length 01A27h 1 06h 06h 06h 06h REF 1.5-V Reference Factor 01A28h 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit REF 2.0-V Reference Factor 01A2Ah 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit REF 2.5-V Reference Factor 01A2Ch 2 per unit per unit per unit per unit Peripheral Descriptor Tag 01A2Eh 1 02h 02h 02h 02h Peripheral Descriptor Length 01A2Fh 1 5Dh 5Dh 5Bh 5Bh Memory 1 2 08h 8Ah 08h 8Ah 08h 8Ah 08h 8Ah Memory 2 2 0Ch 86h 0Ch 86h 0Ch 86h 0Ch 86h Memory 3 2 12h 2Eh 12h 2Eh 12h 2Eh 12h 2Eh Memory 4 2 22h 96h 22h 94h 22h 96h 22h 94h Memory 5 2 N/A N/A N/A N/A Memory 6 1/2 N/A N/A N/A N/A delimiter 1 00h 00h 00h 00h NA = Not applicable, blank = unused and reads FFh. Detailed Description Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Table 6-55. MSP430F521x Device Descriptor Table(1) (continued) SIZE (BYTES) F5219 F5217 F5214 F5212 VALUE VALUE VALUE VALUE 1 1Fh 1Fh 1Eh 1Eh MSP430CPUXV2 2 00h 23h 00h 23h 00h 23h 00h 23h JTAG 2 00h 09h 00h 09h 00h 09h 00h 09h SBW 2 00h 0Fh 00h 0Fh 00h 0Fh 00h 0Fh EEM-S 2 00h 03h 00h 03h 00h 03h 00h 05h TI BSL 2 00h FCh 00h FCh 00h FCh 00h FCh SFR 2 10h 41h 10h 41h 10h 41h 10h 41h PMM 2 02h 30h 02h 30h 02h 30h 02h 30h FCTL 2 02h 38h 02h 38h 02h 38h 02h 38h CRC16 2 01h 3Ch 01h 3Ch 01h 3Ch 01h 3Ch CRC16_RB 2 00h 3Dh 00h 3Dh 00h 3Dh 00h 3Dh RAMCTL 2 00h 44h 00h 44h 00h 44h 00h 44h WDT_A 2 00h 40h 00h 40h 00h 40h 00h 40h UCS 2 01h 48h 01h 48h 01h 48h 01h 48h SYS 2 02h 42h 02h 42h 02h 42h 02h 42h REF 2 03h A0h 03h A0h 03h A0h 03h A0h Port Mapping 2 01h 10h 01h 10h 01h 10h 01h 10h Port 1/2 2 04h 51h 04h 51h 04h 51h 04h 51h Port 3/4 2 02h 52h 02h 52h 02h 52h 02h 52h Port 5/6 2 02h 53h 02h 53h 02h 53h 02h 53h Port 7/8 2 02h 54h 02h 54h N/A N/A JTAG 2 0Ch 5Fh 0Ch 5Fh 0Eh 5Fh 0Eh 5Fh TA0 2 02h 62h 02h 62h 02h 62h 02h 62h TA1 2 04h 61h 04h 61h 04h 61h 04h 61h TB0 2 04h 67h 04h 67h 04h 67h 04h 67h TA2 2 04h 61h 04h 61h 04h 61h 04h 61h RTC 2 0Ah 68h 0Ah 68h 0Ah 68h 0Ah 68h MPY32 2 02h 85h 02h 85h 02h 85h 02h 85h DESCRIPTION Peripheral count ADDRESS Detailed Description Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 101 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com Table 6-55. MSP430F521x Device Descriptor Table(1) (continued) DESCRIPTION Interrupts 102 Detailed Description ADDRESS SIZE (BYTES) F5219 F5217 F5214 F5212 VALUE VALUE VALUE VALUE DMA-3 2 04h 47h 04h 47h 04h 47h 04h 47h USCI_A/B 2 0Ch 90h 0Ch 90h 0Ch 90h 0Ch 90h USCI_A/B 2 04h 90h 04h 90h 04h 90h 04h 90h ADC10_A 2 N/A N/A N/A N/A COMP_B 2 2Ch A8h 2Ch A8h 2Ch A8h 2Ch A8h COMP_B 1 A8h A8h A8h A8h TB0.CCIFG0 1 64h 64h 64h 64h TB0.CCIFG1..6 1 65h 65h 65h 65h WDTIFG 1 40h 40h 40h 40h USCI_A0 1 90h 90h 90h 90h USCI_B0 1 91h 91h 91h 91h Reserved 1 01h 01h 01h 01h TA0.CCIFG0 1 60h 60h 60h 60h TA0.CCIFG1..4 1 61h 61h 61h 61h Reserved 1 01h 01h 01h 01h DMA 1 46h 46h 46h 46h TA1.CCIFG0 1 62h 62h 62h 62h TA1.CCIFG1..2 1 63h 63h 63h 63h P1 1 50h 50h 50h 50h USCI_A1 1 92h 92h 92h 92h USCI_B1 1 93h 93h 93h 93h TA2.CCIFG0 1 66h 66h 66h 66h TA2.CCIFG1..2 1 67h 67h 67h 67h P2 1 51h 51h 51h 51h RTC_A 1 68h 68h 68h 68h delimiter 1 00h 00h 00h 00h Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 7 Device and Documentation Support 7.1 Device Support 7.1.1 Getting Started For more information on the MSP430™ family of devices and the tools and libraries that are available to help with your development, visit the Getting Started page. 7.1.2 Development Tools Support All MSP430™ microcontrollers are supported by a wide variety of software and hardware development tools. Tools are available from TI and various third parties. See them all at www.ti.com/msp430tools. 7.1.2.1 Hardware Features See the Code Composer Studio for MSP430 User's Guide (SLAU157) for details on the available features. MSP430 Architecture 4-Wire JTAG 2-Wire JTAG Breakpoints (N) Range Breakpoints Clock Control State Sequencer Trace Buffer LPMx.5 Debugging Support MSP430Xv2 Yes Yes 8 Yes Yes Yes Yes No 7.1.2.2 Recommended Hardware Options 7.1.2.2.1 Target Socket Boards The target socket boards allow easy programming and debugging of the device using JTAG. They also feature header pin outs for prototyping. Target socket boards are orderable individually or as a kit with the JTAG programmer and debugger included. The following table shows the compatible target boards and the supported packages. Package Target Board and Programmer Bundle Target Board Only 64-pin VQFN (RGC) MSP-FET430U64C MSP-TS430RGC64C 7.1.2.2.2 Experimenter Boards Experimenter Boards and Evaluation kits are available for some MSP430 devices. These kits feature additional hardware components and connectivity for full system evaluation and prototyping. See www.ti.com/msp430tools for details. 7.1.2.2.3 Debugging and Programming Tools Hardware programming and debugging tools are available from TI and from its third party suppliers. See the full list of available tools at www.ti.com/msp430tools. 7.1.2.2.4 Production Programmers The production programmers expedite loading firmware to devices by programming several devices simultaneously. Part Number PC Port MSP-GANG Serial and USB 7.1.2.3 Features Program up to eight devices at a time. Works with PC or standalone. Provider Texas Instruments Recommended Software Options 7.1.2.3.1 Integrated Development Environments Software development tools are available from TI or from third parties. Open source solutions are also available. This device is supported by Code Composer Studio™ IDE (CCS). Device and Documentation Support Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 103 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 www.ti.com 7.1.2.3.2 MSP430Ware MSP430Ware is a collection of code examples, data sheets, and other design resources for all MSP430 devices delivered in a convenient package. In addition to providing a complete collection of existing MSP430 design resources, MSP430Ware also includes a high-level API called MSP430 Driver Library. This library makes it easy to program MSP430 hardware. MSP430Ware is available as a component of CCS or as a standalone package. 7.1.2.3.3 SYS/BIOS SYS/BIOS is an advanced real-time operating system for the MSP430 microcontrollers. It features preemptive deterministic multi-tasking, hardware abstraction, memory management, and real-time analysis. SYS/BIOS is available free of charge and is provided with full source code. 7.1.2.3.4 Command-Line Programmer MSP430 Flasher is an open-source, shell-based interface for programming MSP430 microcontrollers through a FET programmer or eZ430 using JTAG or Spy-Bi-Wire (SBW) communication. MSP430 Flasher can be used to download binary files (.txt or .hex) files directly to the MSP430 microcontroller without the need for an IDE. 7.1.3 Device and Development Tool Nomenclature To designate the stages in the product development cycle, TI assigns prefixes to the part numbers of all MSP430 MCU devices and support tools. Each MSP430 MCU commercial family member has one of three prefixes: MSP, PMS, or XMS (for example, MSP430F5438A). TI recommends two of three possible prefix designators for its support tools: MSP and MSPX. These prefixes represent evolutionary stages of product development from engineering prototypes (with XMS for devices and MSPX for tools) through fully qualified production devices and tools (with MSP for devices and MSP for tools). Device development evolutionary flow: XMS – Experimental device that is not necessarily representative of the electrical specifications for the final device PMS – Final silicon die that conforms to the electrical specifications for the device but has not completed quality and reliability verification MSP – Fully qualified production device Support tool development evolutionary flow: MSPX – Development-support product that has not yet completed TI's internal qualification testing. MSP – Fully-qualified development-support product XMS and PMS devices and MSPX development-support tools are shipped against the following disclaimer: "Developmental product is intended for internal evaluation purposes." MSP devices and MSP development-support tools have been characterized fully, and the quality and reliability of the device have been demonstrated fully. TI's standard warranty applies. Predictions show that prototype devices (XMS and PMS) have a greater failure rate than the standard production devices. TI recommends that these devices not be used in any production system because their expected end-use failure rate still is undefined. Only qualified production devices are to be used. TI device nomenclature also includes a suffix with the device family name. This suffix indicates the package type (for example, PZP) and temperature range (for example, T). Figure 7-1 provides a legend for reading the complete device name for any family member. 104 Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 MSP 430 F 5 438 A I ZQW T -EP Processor Family Optional: Additional Features MCU Platform Optional: Tape and Reel Device Type Packaging Series Feature Set Processor Family Optional: Temperature Range Optional: A = Revision CC = Embedded RF Radio MSP = Mixed-Signal Processor XMS = Experimental Silicon PMS = Prototype Device 430 = MSP430 low-power microcontroller platform MCU Platform Device Type Memory Type C = ROM F = Flash FR = FRAM G = Flash or FRAM (Value Line) L = No Nonvolatile Memory Series 1 Series = Up to 8 MHz 2 Series = Up to 16 MHz 3 Series = Legacy 4 Series = Up to 16 MHz with LCD Feature Set Various Levels of Integration Within a Series Optional: A = Revision N/A Specialized Application AFE = Analog Front End BT = Preprogrammed with Bluetooth BQ = Contactless Power CG = ROM Medical FE = Flash Energy Meter FG = Flash Medical FW = Flash Electronic Flow Meter 5 Series = Up to 25 MHz 6 Series = Up to 25 MHz with LCD 0 = Low-Voltage Series Optional: Temperature Range S = 0°C to 50°C C = 0°C to 70°C I = –40°C to 85°C T = –40°C to 105°C Packaging http://www.ti.com/packaging Optional: Tape and Reel T = Small Reel R = Large Reel No Markings = Tube or Tray Optional: Additional Features -EP = Enhanced Product (–40°C to 105°C) -HT = Extreme Temperature Parts (–55°C to 150°C) -Q1 = Automotive Q100 Qualified Figure 7-1. Device Nomenclature Device and Documentation Support Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 105 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 7.2 www.ti.com Documentation Support The following documents describe the MSP430F522x and MSP430F521x devices. Copies of these documents are available on the Internet at www.ti.com. 7.3 SLAU208 MSP430x5xx and MSP430x6xx Family User's Guide .Detailed information on the modules and peripherals available in this device family. SLAZ263 MSP430F5229 Device Erratasheet. Describes the known exceptions to the functional specifications for the MSP430F5229 device. SLAZ261 MSP430F5227 Device Erratasheet. Describes the known exceptions to the functional specifications for the MSP430F5227 device. SLAZ260 MSP430F5224 Device Erratasheet. Describes the known exceptions to the functional specifications for the MSP430F5224 device. SLAZ258 MSP430F5222 Device Erratasheet. Describes the known exceptions to the functional specifications for the MSP430F5222 device. SLAZ257 MSP430F5219 Device Erratasheet. Describes the known exceptions to the functional specifications for the MSP430F5219 device. SLAZ255 MSP430F5217 Device Erratasheet. Describes the known exceptions to the functional specifications for the MSP430F5217 device. SLAZ254 MSP430F5214 Device Erratasheet. Describes the known exceptions to the functional specifications for the MSP430F5214 device. SLAZ252 MSP430F5212 Device Erratasheet. Describes the known exceptions to the functional specifications for the MSP430F5212 device. Related Links Table 7-1 lists quick access links. Categories include technical documents, support and community resources, tools and software, and quick access to sample or buy. Table 7-1. Related Links 106 PARTS PRODUCT FOLDER SAMPLE & BUY TECHNICAL DOCUMENTS TOOLS & SOFTWARE SUPPORT & COMMUNITY MSP430F5229 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here MSP430F5227 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here MSP430F5224 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here MSP430F5222 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here MSP430F5219 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here MSP430F5217 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here MSP430F5214 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here MSP430F5212 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 MSP430F5229, MSP430F5227, MSP430F5224, MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219, MSP430F5217, MSP430F5214, MSP430F5212 www.ti.com 7.4 SLAS718F – NOVEMBER 2012 – REVISED NOVEMBER 2015 Community Resources The following links connect to TI community resources. Linked contents are provided "AS IS" by the respective contributors. They do not constitute TI specifications and do not necessarily reflect TI's views; see TI's Terms of Use. TI E2E™ Community TI's Engineer-to-Engineer (E2E) Community. Created to foster collaboration among engineers. At e2e.ti.com, you can ask questions, share knowledge, explore ideas, and help solve problems with fellow engineers. TI Embedded Processors Wiki Texas Instruments Embedded Processors Wiki. Established to help developers get started with embedded processors from Texas Instruments and to foster innovation and growth of general knowledge about the hardware and software surrounding these devices. 7.5 Trademarks MSP430, Code Composer Studio, E2E are trademarks of Texas Instruments. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. 7.6 Electrostatic Discharge Caution This integrated circuit can be damaged by ESD. Texas Instruments recommends that all integrated circuits be handled with appropriate precautions. Failure to observe proper handling and installation procedures can cause damage. ESD damage can range from subtle performance degradation to complete device failure. Precision integrated circuits may be more susceptible to damage because very small parametric changes could cause the device not to meet its published specifications. 7.7 Export Control Notice Recipient agrees to not knowingly export or re-export, directly or indirectly, any product or technical data (as defined by the U.S., EU, and other Export Administration Regulations) including software, or any controlled product restricted by other applicable national regulations, received from disclosing party under nondisclosure obligations (if any), or any direct product of such technology, to any destination to which such export or re-export is restricted or prohibited by U.S. or other applicable laws, without obtaining prior authorization from U.S. Department of Commerce and other competent Government authorities to the extent required by those laws. 7.8 Glossary TI Glossary This glossary lists and explains terms, acronyms, and definitions. 8 Mechanical, Packaging, and Orderable Information The following pages include mechanical, packaging, and orderable information. This information is the most current data available for the designated devices. This data is subject to change without notice and revision of this document. For browser-based versions of this data sheet, refer to the left-hand navigation. Mechanical, Packaging, and Orderable Information Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: MSP430F5229 MSP430F5227 MSP430F5224 MSP430F5222 MSP430F5219 MSP430F5217 MSP430F5214 MSP430F5212 Copyright © 2012–2015, Texas Instruments Incorporated 107 PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 5-Oct-2015 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Pins Package Drawing Qty Eco Plan Lead/Ball Finish MSL Peak Temp (2) (6) (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) MSP430F5212IRGZR ACTIVE VQFN RGZ 48 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5212 MSP430F5212IRGZT ACTIVE VQFN RGZ 48 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5212 MSP430F5214IRGZR ACTIVE VQFN RGZ 48 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5214 MSP430F5214IRGZT ACTIVE VQFN RGZ 48 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5214 MSP430F5217IRGCR ACTIVE VQFN RGC 64 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5217 MSP430F5217IRGCT ACTIVE VQFN RGC 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5217 MSP430F5217IYFFR ACTIVE DSBGA YFF 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 M430F5217 MSP430F5217IZQE ACTIVE BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 360 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5217 MSP430F5217IZQER ACTIVE BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5217 MSP430F5219IRGCR ACTIVE VQFN RGC 64 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5219 MSP430F5219IRGCT ACTIVE VQFN RGC 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5219 MSP430F5219IYFFR ACTIVE DSBGA YFF 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 M430F5219 MSP430F5219IYFFT ACTIVE DSBGA YFF 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 M430F5219 MSP430F5219IZQE ACTIVE BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 360 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5219 MSP430F5219IZQER ACTIVE BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5219 Addendum-Page 1 Samples PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com Orderable Device 5-Oct-2015 Status (1) Package Type Package Pins Package Drawing Qty Eco Plan Lead/Ball Finish MSL Peak Temp (2) (6) (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) MSP430F5222IRGZR ACTIVE VQFN RGZ 48 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5222 MSP430F5222IRGZT ACTIVE VQFN RGZ 48 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5222 MSP430F5223IRGZT NRND VQFN RGZ 48 TBD Call TI Call TI -40 to 85 F5223 MSP430F5224IRGZR ACTIVE VQFN RGZ 48 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5224 MSP430F5227IRGCR ACTIVE VQFN RGC 64 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5227 MSP430F5227IYFFR ACTIVE DSBGA YFF 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 M430F5227 MSP430F5227IZQE ACTIVE BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 360 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5227 MSP430F5227IZQER ACTIVE BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5227 MSP430F5229IRGCR ACTIVE VQFN RGC 64 2000 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5229 MSP430F5229IRGCT ACTIVE VQFN RGC 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) CU NIPDAU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5229 MSP430F5229IYFFR ACTIVE DSBGA YFF 64 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 M430F5229 MSP430F5229IYFFT ACTIVE DSBGA YFF 64 250 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-1-260C-UNLIM -40 to 85 M430F5229 MSP430F5229IZQE ACTIVE BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 360 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5229 MSP430F5229IZQER ACTIVE BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 2500 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR -40 to 85 F5229 (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. Addendum-Page 2 Samples PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 5-Oct-2015 (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. Addendum-Page 3 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 28-Apr-2015 TAPE AND REEL INFORMATION *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Package Pins Type Drawing SPQ Reel Reel A0 Diameter Width (mm) (mm) W1 (mm) B0 (mm) K0 (mm) P1 (mm) W Pin1 (mm) Quadrant MSP430F5212IRGZT VQFN RGZ 48 250 180.0 16.4 7.3 7.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5214IRGZR VQFN RGZ 48 2500 330.0 16.4 7.3 7.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5214IRGZT VQFN RGZ 48 250 180.0 16.4 7.3 7.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5217IRGCR VQFN RGC 64 2000 330.0 16.4 9.3 9.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5217IRGCT VQFN RGC 64 250 180.0 16.4 9.3 9.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5217IYFFR DSBGA YFF 64 2500 330.0 12.4 3.54 3.66 0.81 8.0 12.0 Q2 MSP430F5217IZQER BGA MI CROSTA R JUNI OR ZQE 80 2000 330.0 12.4 5.3 5.3 1.5 8.0 12.0 Q1 VQFN RGC 64 2000 330.0 16.4 9.3 9.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5219IRGCT VQFN RGC 64 250 180.0 16.4 9.3 9.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5219IYFFR DSBGA YFF 64 2500 330.0 12.4 3.54 3.66 0.81 8.0 12.0 Q2 MSP430F5219IYFFT DSBGA YFF 64 250 180.0 12.4 3.54 3.66 0.81 8.0 12.0 Q2 MSP430F5219IZQER BGA MI CROSTA R JUNI OR ZQE 80 2500 330.0 12.4 5.3 5.3 1.5 8.0 12.0 Q1 MSP430F5219IRGCR MSP430F5222IRGZR VQFN RGZ 48 2500 330.0 16.4 7.3 7.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5222IRGZT VQFN RGZ 48 250 180.0 16.4 7.3 7.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 Pack Materials-Page 1 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 28-Apr-2015 Device Package Package Pins Type Drawing SPQ Reel Reel A0 Diameter Width (mm) (mm) W1 (mm) B0 (mm) K0 (mm) P1 (mm) W Pin1 (mm) Quadrant MSP430F5224IRGZR VQFN RGZ 48 2500 330.0 16.4 7.3 7.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5227IRGCR VQFN RGC 64 2000 330.0 16.4 9.3 9.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5227IYFFR DSBGA YFF 64 2500 330.0 12.4 3.54 3.66 0.81 8.0 12.0 Q2 MSP430F5227IZQER BGA MI CROSTA R JUNI OR ZQE 80 2500 330.0 12.4 5.3 5.3 1.5 8.0 12.0 Q1 VQFN RGC 64 2000 330.0 16.4 9.3 9.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5229IRGCT VQFN RGC 64 250 180.0 16.4 9.3 9.3 1.1 12.0 16.0 Q2 MSP430F5229IYFFR DSBGA YFF 64 2500 330.0 12.4 3.54 3.66 0.81 8.0 12.0 Q2 MSP430F5229IYFFT DSBGA YFF 64 250 180.0 12.4 3.54 3.66 0.81 8.0 12.0 Q2 MSP430F5229IZQER BGA MI CROSTA R JUNI OR ZQE 80 2500 330.0 12.4 5.3 5.3 1.5 8.0 12.0 Q1 MSP430F5229IRGCR *All dimensions are nominal Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm) MSP430F5212IRGZT VQFN RGZ 48 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 MSP430F5214IRGZR VQFN RGZ 48 2500 367.0 367.0 38.0 MSP430F5214IRGZT VQFN RGZ 48 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 MSP430F5217IRGCR VQFN RGC 64 2000 367.0 367.0 38.0 Pack Materials-Page 2 PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION www.ti.com 28-Apr-2015 Device Package Type Package Drawing Pins SPQ Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm) MSP430F5217IRGCT VQFN RGC 64 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 MSP430F5217IYFFR DSBGA YFF 64 2500 367.0 367.0 35.0 MSP430F5217IZQER BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 2000 338.1 338.1 20.6 MSP430F5219IRGCR VQFN RGC 64 2000 367.0 367.0 38.0 MSP430F5219IRGCT VQFN RGC 64 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 MSP430F5219IYFFR DSBGA YFF 64 2500 367.0 367.0 35.0 MSP430F5219IYFFT DSBGA YFF 64 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 MSP430F5219IZQER BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 2500 338.1 338.1 20.6 MSP430F5222IRGZR VQFN RGZ 48 2500 367.0 367.0 38.0 MSP430F5222IRGZT VQFN RGZ 48 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 MSP430F5224IRGZR VQFN RGZ 48 2500 367.0 367.0 38.0 MSP430F5227IRGCR VQFN RGC 64 2000 367.0 367.0 38.0 MSP430F5227IYFFR DSBGA YFF 64 2500 367.0 367.0 35.0 MSP430F5227IZQER BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 2500 338.1 338.1 20.6 MSP430F5229IRGCR VQFN RGC 64 2000 367.0 367.0 38.0 MSP430F5229IRGCT VQFN RGC 64 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 MSP430F5229IYFFR DSBGA YFF 64 2500 367.0 367.0 35.0 MSP430F5229IYFFT DSBGA YFF 64 250 210.0 185.0 35.0 MSP430F5229IZQER BGA MICROSTAR JUNIOR ZQE 80 2500 338.1 338.1 20.6 Pack Materials-Page 3 D: Max = 3.565 mm, Min =3.505 mm E: Max = 3.445 mm, Min =3.385 mm IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated